1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6 <ian@cygnus.com>.
7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8 <mark@codesourcery.com>
9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
11
12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
13
14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
17 (at your option) any later version.
18
19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
22 GNU General Public License for more details.
23
24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27
28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
29
30 #include "sysdep.h"
31 #include "bfd.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "libiberty.h"
34 #include "elf-bfd.h"
35 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
36 #include "elf/mips.h"
37 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
38
39 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
40 #include "coff/sym.h"
41 #include "coff/symconst.h"
42 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
43 #include "coff/mips.h"
44
45 #include "hashtab.h"
46
47 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
48 There are three types of entry:
49
50 (1) absolute addresses
51 (abfd == NULL)
52 (2) SYMBOL + OFFSET addresses, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
53 (abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0)
54 (3) global and forced-local symbols
55 (abfd != NULL, symndx == -1)
56
57 Type (3) entries are treated differently for different types of GOT.
58 In the "master" GOT -- i.e. the one that describes every GOT
59 reference needed in the link -- the mips_got_entry is keyed on both
60 the symbol and the input bfd that references it. If it turns out
61 that we need multiple GOTs, we can then use this information to
62 create separate GOTs for each input bfd.
63
64 However, we want each of these separate GOTs to have at most one
65 entry for a given symbol, so their type (3) entries are keyed only
66 on the symbol. The input bfd given by the "abfd" field is somewhat
67 arbitrary in this case.
68
69 This means that when there are multiple GOTs, each GOT has a unique
70 mips_got_entry for every symbol within it. We can therefore use the
71 mips_got_entry fields (tls_type and gotidx) to track the symbol's
72 GOT index.
73
74 However, if it turns out that we need only a single GOT, we continue
75 to use the master GOT to describe it. There may therefore be several
76 mips_got_entries for the same symbol, each with a different input bfd.
77 We want to make sure that each symbol gets a unique GOT entry, so when
78 there's a single GOT, we use the symbol's hash entry, not the
79 mips_got_entry fields, to track a symbol's GOT index. */
80 struct mips_got_entry
81 {
82 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
83 bfd *abfd;
84 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
85 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
86 long symndx;
87 union
88 {
89 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
90 bfd_vma address;
91 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
92 that should be added to the symbol value. */
93 bfd_vma addend;
94 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
95 corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
96 h->forced_local). */
97 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
98 } d;
99
100 /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
101 IE). The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
102 relocations. LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
103 combined with any GD or IE flags. An LDM GOT entry will be
104 a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
105 unsigned char tls_type;
106
107 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
108 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
109 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
110 long gotidx;
111 };
112
113 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
114
115 struct mips_got_info
116 {
117 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
118 symbol table. */
119 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
120 /* The number of global .got entries. */
121 unsigned int global_gotno;
122 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
123 unsigned int tls_gotno;
124 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
125 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
126 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
127 /* The number of local .got entries. */
128 unsigned int local_gotno;
129 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
130 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
131 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
132 struct htab *got_entries;
133 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
134 unless multi-got was necessary. */
135 struct htab *bfd2got;
136 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
137 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
138 struct mips_got_info *next;
139 /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
140 for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned. This is needed
141 because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
142 for the LDM. It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode. */
143 bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
144 };
145
146 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
147
148 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
149 bfd *bfd;
150 struct mips_got_info *g;
151 };
152
153 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
154 create and merge bfd's gots. */
155
156 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
157 {
158 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
159 htab_t bfd2got;
160 /* The output bfd. */
161 bfd *obfd;
162 /* The link information. */
163 struct bfd_link_info *info;
164 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
165 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
166 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
167 struct mips_got_info *primary;
168 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
169 gots. */
170 struct mips_got_info *current;
171 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
172 16-bit offset. */
173 unsigned int max_count;
174 /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got. */
175 unsigned int primary_count;
176 /* The number of local and global entries in the current got. */
177 unsigned int current_count;
178 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
179 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
180 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
181 the "master" GOT. */
182 unsigned int global_count;
183 };
184
185 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
186
187 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
188 {
189 struct mips_got_info *g;
190 int value;
191 unsigned int needed_relocs;
192 struct bfd_link_info *info;
193 };
194
195 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
196 entry or ELF symbol table traversal. */
197
198 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
199 {
200 struct bfd_link_info *info;
201 unsigned int needed;
202 };
203
204 struct _mips_elf_section_data
205 {
206 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
207 union
208 {
209 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
210 bfd_byte *tdata;
211 } u;
212 };
213
214 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
215 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
216
217 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
218 the dynamic symbols. */
219
220 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
221 {
222 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
223 index. */
224 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
225 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
226 symbol with a GOT entry. */
227 long min_got_dynindx;
228 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
229 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
230 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
231 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
232 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
233 symbol without a GOT entry. */
234 long max_non_got_dynindx;
235 };
236
237 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
238 the global hash table. */
239
240 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
241 {
242 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
243
244 /* External symbol information. */
245 EXTR esym;
246
247 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
248 this symbol. */
249 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
250
251 /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
252 a readonly section. */
253 bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
254
255 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
256 related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
257 R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
258 p. 4-20. */
259 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
260
261 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
262 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
263 asection *fn_stub;
264
265 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
266 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
267 bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
268
269 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
270 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
271 asection *call_stub;
272
273 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
274 being called returns a floating point value. */
275 asection *call_fp_stub;
276
277 /* Are we forced local? This will only be set if we have converted
278 the initial global GOT entry to a local GOT entry. */
279 bfd_boolean forced_local;
280
281 /* Are we referenced by some kind of relocation? */
282 bfd_boolean is_relocation_target;
283
284 /* Are we referenced by branch relocations? */
285 bfd_boolean is_branch_target;
286
287 #define GOT_NORMAL 0
288 #define GOT_TLS_GD 1
289 #define GOT_TLS_LDM 2
290 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4
291 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE 0x40
292 #define GOT_TLS_DONE 0x80
293 unsigned char tls_type;
294 /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
295 is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
296 there. In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
297 structures all referring to the same GOT slot. It might be
298 possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
299 overloaded already. */
300 bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
301 };
302
303 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
304
305 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
306 {
307 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
308 #if 0
309 /* We no longer use this. */
310 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
311 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
312 #endif
313 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
314 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
315 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
316 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
317 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
318 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
319 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
320 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
321 bfd_vma rld_value;
322 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
323 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
324 /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks. */
325 bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
326 /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
327 being used. */
328 asection *srelbss;
329 asection *sdynbss;
330 asection *srelplt;
331 asection *srelplt2;
332 asection *sgotplt;
333 asection *splt;
334 /* The size of the PLT header in bytes (VxWorks only). */
335 bfd_vma plt_header_size;
336 /* The size of a PLT entry in bytes (VxWorks only). */
337 bfd_vma plt_entry_size;
338 /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes. */
339 bfd_vma function_stub_size;
340 };
341
342 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
343 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
344 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
345 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
346 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
347 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
348 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
349 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
350 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
351 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
352 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
353 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
354 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
355 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
356
357 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
358
359 struct extsym_info
360 {
361 bfd *abfd;
362 struct bfd_link_info *info;
363 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
364 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
365 bfd_boolean failed;
366 };
367
368 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
369
370 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
371 {
372 "_procedure_table",
373 "_procedure_string_table",
374 "_procedure_table_size",
375 NULL
376 };
377
378 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
379 IRIX5. */
380
381 typedef struct
382 {
383 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
384 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
385 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
386 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
387 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
388 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
389 } Elf32_compact_rel;
390
391 typedef struct
392 {
393 bfd_byte id1[4];
394 bfd_byte num[4];
395 bfd_byte id2[4];
396 bfd_byte offset[4];
397 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
398 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
399 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
400
401 typedef struct
402 {
403 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
404 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
405 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
406 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
407 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
408 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
409 } Elf32_crinfo;
410
411 typedef struct
412 {
413 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
414 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
415 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
416 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
417 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
418 } Elf32_crinfo2;
419
420 typedef struct
421 {
422 bfd_byte info[4];
423 bfd_byte konst[4];
424 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
425 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
426
427 typedef struct
428 {
429 bfd_byte info[4];
430 bfd_byte konst[4];
431 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
432
433 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
434
435 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
436 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
437 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
438 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
439 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
440 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
441 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
442 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
443
444 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
445 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
446 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
447 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
448 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
449
450 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
451 has different meaning for each type:
452
453 (type) (konst)
454 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
455 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
456 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
457 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
458 */
459
460 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
461 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
462 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
463 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
464
465 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
466 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
467 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
468 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
469
470 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
471 loader for use by the static exception system. */
472
473 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
474 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
475 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
476 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
477 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
478 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
479 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
480 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
481 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
482 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
483 long reserved;
484 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
485 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
486 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
487 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
488
489 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
490 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *,
491 bfd_vma, unsigned long, struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
492 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
493 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
494 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
495 (bfd_vma);
496 static bfd_boolean mips16_stub_section_p
497 (bfd *, asection *);
498 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
499 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
500 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
501 bfd_vma *, asection *);
502 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
503 (const void *);
504 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
505 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
506 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
507 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
508
509 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
510 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
511
512 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
513 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
514 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
515
516 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
517 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
518 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
519
520 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
521 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
522
523 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
524 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
525 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
526
527 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
528 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
529 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
530
531 /* The name of the options section. */
532 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
533 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
534
535 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
536 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
537 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
538 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
539
540 /* Whether the section is readonly. */
541 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
542 ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)) \
543 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
544
545 /* The name of the stub section. */
546 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
547
548 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
549 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
550 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
551
552 /* The size of an external RELA relocation. */
553 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
554 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
555
556 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
557 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
558 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
559
560 /* The size of the rld_map pointer. */
561 #define MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE(abfd) \
562 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
563
564 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
565 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
566 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
567
568 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
569 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
570 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
571
572 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
573 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
574 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
575
576 /* Get word-sized data. */
577 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
578 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
579
580 /* Put out word-sized data. */
581 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
582 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
583 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
584 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
585
586 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
587 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
588 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
589
590 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
591 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
592
593 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
594 (zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are
595 two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
596 the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is
597 in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
598 relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if
599 rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
600 section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
601 section, that is RELA. */
602 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \
603 ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \
604 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \
605 > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \
606 == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \
607 == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \
608 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
609
610 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section. */
611 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
612 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
613
614 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
615 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
616 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
617 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
618
619 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */
620 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO(INFO) \
621 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 3 : 2)
622
623 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
624 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
625 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
626
627 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
628 offsets from $gp. */
629 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
630
631 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
632 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
633 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
634 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
635 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
636 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
637 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
638 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
639 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
640 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
641 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
642 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
643 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
644 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL) \
645 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
646 ? (0x64180000 + (VAL)) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
647 : (0x24180000 + (VAL)))) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
648
649 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
650 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
651
652 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
653 section. */
654
655 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
656 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
657 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
658 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
659
660 #ifdef BFD64
661 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
662 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
663 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
664 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
665 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
666 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
667 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
668 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
669 #else
670 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
671 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
672 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
673 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
674 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
675 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
676 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
677 #endif
678
679 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
680 floating point arguments.
681
682 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
683 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
684 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
685 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
686 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
687 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
688 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
689 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
690
691 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
692 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
693 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
694 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
695 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
696 stub should be discarded.
697
698 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
699 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
700 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
701 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
702 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
703 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
704 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
705 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
706
707 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
708 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
709 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
710
711 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
712
713 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
714 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
715 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
716
717 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
718 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
719 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
720
721 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable. */
722 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] = {
723 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
724 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
725 0x8f390008, /* lw t9, 8(t9) */
726 0x00000000, /* nop */
727 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
728 0x00000000 /* nop */
729 };
730
731 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
732 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] = {
733 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
734 0x24180000, /* li t8, <pltindex> */
735 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>) */
736 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>) */
737 0x8f390000, /* lw t9, 0(t9) */
738 0x00000000, /* nop */
739 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
740 0x00000000 /* nop */
741 };
742
743 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object. */
744 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] = {
745 0x8f990008, /* lw t9, 8(gp) */
746 0x00000000, /* nop */
747 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
748 0x00000000, /* nop */
749 0x00000000, /* nop */
750 0x00000000 /* nop */
751 };
752
753 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
754 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] = {
755 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
756 0x24180000 /* li t8, <pltindex> */
757 };
758
759 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
760
761 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
762 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
763 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
764 (copy), (follow)))
765
766 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
767
768 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
769 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
770 (&(table)->root, \
771 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
772 (info)))
773
774 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
775
776 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
777 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
778
779 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
780 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
781
782 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
783 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
784
785 static bfd_vma
dtprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)786 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
787 {
788 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
789 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
790 return 0;
791 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
792 }
793
794 static bfd_vma
tprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)795 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
796 {
797 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
798 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
799 return 0;
800 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
801 }
802
803 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
804
805 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc(struct bfd_hash_entry * entry,struct bfd_hash_table * table,const char * string)806 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
807 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
808 {
809 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
810 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
811
812 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
813 subclass. */
814 if (ret == NULL)
815 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
816 if (ret == NULL)
817 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
818
819 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
820 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
821 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
822 table, string));
823 if (ret != NULL)
824 {
825 /* Set local fields. */
826 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
827 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
828 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
829 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
830 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
831 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
832 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
833 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
834 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
835 ret->call_stub = NULL;
836 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
837 ret->forced_local = FALSE;
838 ret->is_branch_target = FALSE;
839 ret->is_relocation_target = FALSE;
840 ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
841 }
842
843 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
844 }
845
846 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)847 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
848 {
849 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
850 {
851 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
852 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
853
854 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
855 if (sdata == NULL)
856 return FALSE;
857 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
858 }
859
860 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
861 }
862
863 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
864 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
865
866 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info(bfd * abfd,asection * section,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)867 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
868 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
869 {
870 HDRR *symhdr;
871 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
872 char *ext_hdr;
873
874 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
875 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
876
877 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
878 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
879 goto error_return;
880
881 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
882 swap->external_hdr_size))
883 goto error_return;
884
885 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
886 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
887
888 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
889 read. */
890 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
891 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
892 debug->ptr = NULL; \
893 else \
894 { \
895 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
896 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
897 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
898 goto error_return; \
899 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
900 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
901 goto error_return; \
902 }
903
904 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
905 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
906 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
907 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
908 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
909 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
910 union aux_ext *);
911 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
912 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
913 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
914 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
915 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
916 #undef READ
917
918 debug->fdr = NULL;
919
920 return TRUE;
921
922 error_return:
923 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
924 free (ext_hdr);
925 if (debug->line != NULL)
926 free (debug->line);
927 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
928 free (debug->external_dnr);
929 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
930 free (debug->external_pdr);
931 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
932 free (debug->external_sym);
933 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
934 free (debug->external_opt);
935 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
936 free (debug->external_aux);
937 if (debug->ss != NULL)
938 free (debug->ss);
939 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
940 free (debug->ssext);
941 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
942 free (debug->external_fdr);
943 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
944 free (debug->external_rfd);
945 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
946 free (debug->external_ext);
947 return FALSE;
948 }
949
950 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
951
952 static void
ecoff_swap_rpdr_out(bfd * abfd,const RPDR * in,struct rpdr_ext * ex)953 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
954 {
955 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
956 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
957 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
958 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
959 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
960 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
961
962 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
963 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
964
965 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
966 }
967
968 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
969
970 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_procedure_table(void * handle,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * s,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)971 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
972 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
973 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
974 {
975 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
976 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
977 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
978 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
979 void *rtproc;
980 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
981 struct sym_ext *esym;
982 char *ss, **sv;
983 char *str;
984 bfd_size_type size;
985 bfd_size_type count;
986 unsigned long sindex;
987 unsigned long i;
988 PDR pdr;
989 SYMR sym;
990 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
991
992 epdr = NULL;
993 rpdr = NULL;
994 esym = NULL;
995 ss = NULL;
996 sv = NULL;
997
998 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
999
1000 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1001 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1002 if (count > 0)
1003 {
1004 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1005
1006 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1007 if (epdr == NULL)
1008 goto error_return;
1009
1010 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1011 goto error_return;
1012
1013 size = sizeof (RPDR);
1014 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1015 if (rpdr == NULL)
1016 goto error_return;
1017
1018 size = sizeof (char *);
1019 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1020 if (sv == NULL)
1021 goto error_return;
1022
1023 count = hdr->isymMax;
1024 size = swap->external_sym_size;
1025 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1026 if (esym == NULL)
1027 goto error_return;
1028
1029 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1030 goto error_return;
1031
1032 count = hdr->issMax;
1033 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1034 if (ss == NULL)
1035 goto error_return;
1036 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1037 goto error_return;
1038
1039 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1040 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1041 {
1042 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1043 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1044 rp->adr = sym.value;
1045 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1046 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1047 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1048 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1049 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1050 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1051 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1052 rp->irpss = sindex;
1053 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1054 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1055 }
1056 }
1057
1058 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1059 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1060 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1061 if (rtproc == NULL)
1062 {
1063 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1064 goto error_return;
1065 }
1066
1067 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1068
1069 erp = rtproc;
1070 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1071 erp++;
1072 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1073 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1074 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1075 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1076 {
1077 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1078 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1079 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1080 }
1081 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1082
1083 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
1084 s->size = size;
1085 s->contents = rtproc;
1086
1087 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1088 matters, but someday it might). */
1089 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1090
1091 if (epdr != NULL)
1092 free (epdr);
1093 if (rpdr != NULL)
1094 free (rpdr);
1095 if (esym != NULL)
1096 free (esym);
1097 if (ss != NULL)
1098 free (ss);
1099 if (sv != NULL)
1100 free (sv);
1101
1102 return TRUE;
1103
1104 error_return:
1105 if (epdr != NULL)
1106 free (epdr);
1107 if (rpdr != NULL)
1108 free (rpdr);
1109 if (esym != NULL)
1110 free (esym);
1111 if (ss != NULL)
1112 free (ss);
1113 if (sv != NULL)
1114 free (sv);
1115 return FALSE;
1116 }
1117
1118 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1119 discard them. */
1120
1121 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1122 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1123 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1124 {
1125 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1126 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1127
1128 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1129 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1130 {
1131 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1132 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1133 being included in the link. */
1134 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1135 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1136 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1137 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1138 }
1139
1140 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1141 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1142 {
1143 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1144 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1145 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1146 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1147 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1148 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1149 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1150 }
1151
1152 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1153 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1154 {
1155 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1156 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1157 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1158 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1159 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1160 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1161 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1162 }
1163
1164 return TRUE;
1165 }
1166
1167 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1168 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1169 are 32 bits.
1170
1171 The format of these instructions is:
1172
1173 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1174 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
1175 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1176 | Immediate 15:0 |
1177 +-----------------------------------------------+
1178
1179 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1180 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1181
1182 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1183 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
1184 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1185 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1186 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1187 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1188 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
1189 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1190 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1191 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1192 instruction.
1193
1194 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1195 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
1196 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
1197 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1198 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1199 value as two 16-bit values.
1200
1201 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1202 defined as
1203
1204 big-endian:
1205 +--------+----------------------+
1206 | | |
1207 | | targ26-16 |
1208 |31 26|25 0|
1209 +--------+----------------------+
1210
1211 little-endian:
1212 +----------+------+-------------+
1213 | | | |
1214 | sub1 | | sub2 |
1215 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
1216 +----------+--------------------+
1217 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1218 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1219
1220 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1221 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1222 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1223 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1224 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1225
1226 R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
1227 mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1228
1229 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1230 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
1231 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1232 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
1233 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1234
1235 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
1236 opcode.
1237
1238 This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
1239 addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
1240 is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
1241
1242 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As
1243 above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1244 little-endian system.
1245
1246 R_MIPS16_HI16 and R_MIPS16_LO16 are used in mips16 mode to
1247 access data when neither GP-relative nor PC-relative addressing
1248 can be used. They are handled like R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16,
1249 except that the addend is retrieved and stored as shown above
1250 for R_MIPS16_GPREL.
1251 */
1252 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1253 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1254 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1255 {
1256 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1257
1258 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1259 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1260 return;
1261
1262 /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction. */
1263 extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1264 insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1265 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1266 {
1267 if (jal_shuffle)
1268 val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1269 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1270 else
1271 val = extend << 16 | insn;
1272 }
1273 else
1274 val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1275 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1276 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1277 }
1278
1279 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1280 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1281 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1282 {
1283 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1284
1285 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1286 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1287 return;
1288
1289 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1290 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1291 {
1292 if (jal_shuffle)
1293 {
1294 insn = val & 0xffff;
1295 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1296 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1297 }
1298 else
1299 {
1300 insn = val & 0xffff;
1301 extend = val >> 16;
1302 }
1303 }
1304 else
1305 {
1306 insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1307 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1308 }
1309 bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1310 bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1311 }
1312
1313 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp(bfd * abfd,asymbol * symbol,arelent * reloc_entry,asection * input_section,bfd_boolean relocatable,void * data,bfd_vma gp)1314 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1315 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1316 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1317 {
1318 bfd_vma relocation;
1319 bfd_signed_vma val;
1320 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1321
1322 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1323 relocation = 0;
1324 else
1325 relocation = symbol->value;
1326
1327 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1328 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1329
1330 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1331 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1332
1333 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
1334 val = reloc_entry->addend;
1335
1336 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1337
1338 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
1339 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1340 an external symbol. */
1341 if (! relocatable
1342 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1343 val += relocation - gp;
1344
1345 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1346 {
1347 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1348 (bfd_byte *) data
1349 + reloc_entry->address);
1350 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1351 return status;
1352 }
1353 else
1354 reloc_entry->addend = val;
1355
1356 if (relocatable)
1357 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1358
1359 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1360 }
1361
1362 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1363 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1364 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1365 INPUT_SECTION. */
1366
1367 struct mips_hi16
1368 {
1369 struct mips_hi16 *next;
1370 bfd_byte *data;
1371 asection *input_section;
1372 arelent rel;
1373 };
1374
1375 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
1376
1377 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1378
1379 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
1380 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1381 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1382
1383 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1384 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1385 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
1386 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
1387
1388 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1389 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1390 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1391 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1392 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1393 {
1394 struct mips_hi16 *n;
1395
1396 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1397 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1398
1399 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1400 if (n == NULL)
1401 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1402
1403 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1404 n->data = data;
1405 n->input_section = input_section;
1406 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1407 mips_hi16_list = n;
1408
1409 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1410 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1411
1412 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1413 }
1414
1415 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just
1416 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1417 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
1418
1419 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1420 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1421 void *data, asection *input_section,
1422 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1423 {
1424 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1425 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1426 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1427 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
1428 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1429 input_section, output_bfd,
1430 error_message);
1431
1432 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1433 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1434 }
1435
1436 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
1437 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1438 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
1439
1440 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1441 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1442 void *data, asection *input_section,
1443 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1444 {
1445 bfd_vma vallo;
1446 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1447
1448 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1449 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1450
1451 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1452 location);
1453 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
1454 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1455 location);
1456
1457 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1458 {
1459 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1460 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1461
1462 hi = mips_hi16_list;
1463
1464 /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
1465 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1466 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
1467 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1468 has a rightshift of 0. */
1469 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1470 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1471
1472 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1473 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
1474 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1475
1476 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1477 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1478 error_message);
1479 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1480 return ret;
1481
1482 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1483 free (hi);
1484 }
1485
1486 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1487 input_section, output_bfd,
1488 error_message);
1489 }
1490
1491 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
1492 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1493 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
1494
1495 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1496 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1497 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1498 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1499 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1500 {
1501 bfd_signed_vma val;
1502 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1503 bfd_boolean relocatable;
1504
1505 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1506
1507 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1508 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1509
1510 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
1511 val = 0;
1512 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1513 {
1514 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1515 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
1516 offset or address. */
1517 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1518 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1519 }
1520
1521 if (!relocatable)
1522 {
1523 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
1524 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
1525 val += symbol->value;
1526 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1527 {
1528 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1529 val -= input_section->output_offset;
1530 val -= reloc_entry->address;
1531 }
1532 }
1533
1534 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
1535 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1536 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
1537 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
1538 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1539 reloc_entry->addend += val;
1540 else
1541 {
1542 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1543
1544 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
1545 val += reloc_entry->addend;
1546
1547 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
1548 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1549 location);
1550 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1551 location);
1552 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1553 location);
1554
1555 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1556 return status;
1557 }
1558
1559 if (relocatable)
1560 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1561
1562 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1563 }
1564
1565 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
1566 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
1567
1568 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_gptab * ex,Elf32_gptab * in)1569 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1570 Elf32_gptab *in)
1571 {
1572 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1573 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1574 }
1575
1576 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_gptab * in,Elf32_External_gptab * ex)1577 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1578 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1579 {
1580 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1581 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1582 }
1583
1584 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_compact_rel * in,Elf32_External_compact_rel * ex)1585 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1586 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1587 {
1588 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1589 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1590 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1591 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1592 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1593 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1594 }
1595
1596 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_crinfo * in,Elf32_External_crinfo * ex)1597 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1598 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1599 {
1600 unsigned long l;
1601
1602 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1603 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1604 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1605 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1606 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1607 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1608 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1609 }
1610
1611 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
1612 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
1613 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
1614
1615 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf32_RegInfo * in)1616 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1617 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1618 {
1619 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1620 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1621 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1622 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1623 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1624 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1625 }
1626
1627 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_RegInfo * in,Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex)1628 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1629 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1630 {
1631 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1632 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1633 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1634 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1635 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1636 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1637 }
1638
1639 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1640 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
1641 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
1642 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
1643 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
1644
1645 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in)1646 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1647 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1648 {
1649 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1650 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1651 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1652 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1653 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1654 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1655 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1656 }
1657
1658 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in,Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex)1659 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1660 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1661 {
1662 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1663 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1664 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1665 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1666 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1667 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1668 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1669 }
1670
1671 /* Swap in an options header. */
1672
1673 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf_External_Options * ex,Elf_Internal_Options * in)1674 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1675 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1676 {
1677 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1678 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1679 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1680 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1681 }
1682
1683 /* Swap out an options header. */
1684
1685 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf_Internal_Options * in,Elf_External_Options * ex)1686 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1687 Elf_External_Options *ex)
1688 {
1689 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1690 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1691 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1692 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1693 }
1694
1695 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1696 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
1697
1698 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs(const void * arg1,const void * arg2)1699 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1700 {
1701 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1702 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1703 int diff;
1704
1705 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1706 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1707
1708 diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1709 if (diff != 0)
1710 return diff;
1711
1712 if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
1713 return -1;
1714 if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
1715 return 1;
1716 return 0;
1717 }
1718
1719 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
1720
1721 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs_64(const void * arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const void * arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1722 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1723 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1724 {
1725 #ifdef BFD64
1726 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1727 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1728
1729 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1730 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1731 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1732 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1733
1734 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1735 return -1;
1736 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1737 return 1;
1738
1739 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1740 return -1;
1741 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1742 return 1;
1743 return 0;
1744 #else
1745 abort ();
1746 #endif
1747 }
1748
1749
1750 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1751 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
1752 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1753 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1754 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1755 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
1756 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1757 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1758 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1759 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1760 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1761 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
1762 when generating a final executable. */
1763
1764 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_output_extsym(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)1765 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1766 {
1767 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1768 bfd_boolean strip;
1769 asection *sec, *output_section;
1770
1771 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1772 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1773
1774 if (h->root.indx == -2)
1775 strip = FALSE;
1776 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
1777 || h->root.ref_dynamic
1778 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
1779 && !h->root.def_regular
1780 && !h->root.ref_regular)
1781 strip = TRUE;
1782 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1783 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1784 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1785 h->root.root.root.string,
1786 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1787 strip = TRUE;
1788 else
1789 strip = FALSE;
1790
1791 if (strip)
1792 return TRUE;
1793
1794 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1795 {
1796 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1797 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1798 h->esym.weakext = 0;
1799 h->esym.reserved = 0;
1800 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1801 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1802 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1803
1804 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1805 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1806 {
1807 const char *name;
1808
1809 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
1810 special symbols. */
1811 name = h->root.root.root.string;
1812 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1813 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1814 {
1815 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1816 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1817 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1818 }
1819 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1820 {
1821 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1822 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1823 h->esym.asym.value =
1824 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1825 }
1826 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1827 {
1828 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1829 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1830 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1831 }
1832 else
1833 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1834 }
1835 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1836 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1837 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1838 else
1839 {
1840 const char *name;
1841
1842 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1843 output_section = sec->output_section;
1844
1845 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1846 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
1847 if (output_section == NULL)
1848 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1849 else
1850 {
1851 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1852
1853 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1854 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1855 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1856 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1857 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1858 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1859 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1860 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1861 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1862 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1863 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1864 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1865 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1866 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1867 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1868 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1869 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1870 else
1871 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1872 }
1873 }
1874
1875 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1876 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1877 }
1878
1879 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1880 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1881 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1882 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1883 {
1884 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1885 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1886 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1887 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1888
1889 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1890 output_section = sec->output_section;
1891 if (output_section != NULL)
1892 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1893 + sec->output_offset
1894 + output_section->vma);
1895 else
1896 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1897 }
1898 else if (h->root.needs_plt)
1899 {
1900 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1901 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1902
1903 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1904 {
1905 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1906 no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1907 }
1908
1909 if (!no_fn_stub)
1910 {
1911 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
1912 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1913 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1914 if (sec == NULL)
1915 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1916 else
1917 {
1918 output_section = sec->output_section;
1919 if (output_section != NULL)
1920 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1921 + sec->output_offset
1922 + output_section->vma);
1923 else
1924 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1925 }
1926 }
1927 }
1928
1929 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1930 h->root.root.root.string,
1931 &h->esym))
1932 {
1933 einfo->failed = TRUE;
1934 return FALSE;
1935 }
1936
1937 return TRUE;
1938 }
1939
1940 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
1941
1942 static int
gptab_compare(const void * p1,const void * p2)1943 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1944 {
1945 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1946 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1947
1948 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1949 }
1950
1951 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
1952
1953 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1954 hash number. */
1955
1956 static INLINE hashval_t
mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma(bfd_vma addr)1957 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1958 {
1959 #ifdef BFD64
1960 return addr + (addr >> 32);
1961 #else
1962 return addr;
1963 #endif
1964 }
1965
1966 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
1967 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
1968 union members. */
1969
1970 static hashval_t
mips_elf_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)1971 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1972 {
1973 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1974
1975 return entry->symndx
1976 + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
1977 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1978 : entry->abfd->id
1979 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
1980 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
1981 }
1982
1983 static int
mips_elf_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)1984 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1985 {
1986 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1987 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1988
1989 /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry. */
1990 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1991 return 0;
1992
1993 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1994 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1995 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1996 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1997 }
1998
1999 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
2000 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
2001 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
2002 accordingly. */
2003
2004 static hashval_t
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2005 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2006 {
2007 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2008
2009 return entry->symndx
2010 + (! entry->abfd
2011 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2012 : entry->symndx >= 0
2013 ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2014 ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
2015 : (entry->abfd->id
2016 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
2017 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
2018 }
2019
2020 static int
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2021 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2022 {
2023 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2024 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2025
2026 /* Any two LDM entries match. */
2027 if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2028 return 1;
2029
2030 /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry. */
2031 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2032 return 0;
2033
2034 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2035 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2036 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
2037 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2038 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2039 }
2040
2041 /* Return the dynamic relocation section. If it doesn't exist, try to
2042 create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL. Also return NULL
2043 if creation fails. */
2044
2045 static asection *
mips_elf_rel_dyn_section(struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean create_p)2046 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
2047 {
2048 const char *dname;
2049 asection *sreloc;
2050 bfd *dynobj;
2051
2052 dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
2053 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2054 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
2055 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
2056 {
2057 sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
2058 (SEC_ALLOC
2059 | SEC_LOAD
2060 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2061 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2062 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2063 | SEC_READONLY));
2064 if (sreloc == NULL
2065 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
2066 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
2067 return NULL;
2068 }
2069 return sreloc;
2070 }
2071
2072 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */
2073
2074 static asection *
mips_elf_got_section(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)2075 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
2076 {
2077 asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
2078 if (sgot == NULL
2079 || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
2080 return NULL;
2081 return sgot;
2082 }
2083
2084 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
2085 INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
2086 section. */
2087
2088 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_info(bfd * abfd,asection ** sgotp)2089 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
2090 {
2091 asection *sgot;
2092 struct mips_got_info *g;
2093
2094 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
2095 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
2096 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
2097 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
2098 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2099
2100 if (sgotp)
2101 *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
2102
2103 return g;
2104 }
2105
2106 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
2107 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
2108 is NULL). */
2109
2110 static int
mips_tls_got_relocs(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned char tls_type,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2111 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
2112 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2113 {
2114 int indx = 0;
2115 int ret = 0;
2116 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2117 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2118
2119 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
2120 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
2121 indx = h->dynindx;
2122
2123 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2124 && (h == NULL
2125 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
2126 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2127 need_relocs = TRUE;
2128
2129 if (!need_relocs)
2130 return FALSE;
2131
2132 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2133 {
2134 ret++;
2135 if (indx != 0)
2136 ret++;
2137 }
2138
2139 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2140 ret++;
2141
2142 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
2143 ret++;
2144
2145 return ret;
2146 }
2147
2148 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2149 ARG1, if it describes a local symbol. */
2150
2151 static int
mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs(void ** arg1,void * arg2)2152 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2153 {
2154 struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2155 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2156
2157 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2158 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2159
2160 return 1;
2161 }
2162
2163 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2164 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2165
2166 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries(void * arg1,void * arg2)2167 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2168 {
2169 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2170 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2171 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2172
2173 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2174 arg->needed += 2;
2175 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2176 arg->needed += 1;
2177
2178 return 1;
2179 }
2180
2181 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2182 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2183
2184 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs(void * arg1,void * arg2)2185 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2186 {
2187 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2188 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2189 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2190
2191 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2192
2193 return 1;
2194 }
2195
2196 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
2197
2198 static void
mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,asection * sreloc,unsigned long indx,int r_type,bfd_vma offset)2199 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2200 asection *sreloc,
2201 unsigned long indx,
2202 int r_type,
2203 bfd_vma offset)
2204 {
2205 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2206
2207 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2208
2209 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2210 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2211
2212 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2213 {
2214 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2215 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2216 (sreloc->contents
2217 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2218 }
2219 else
2220 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2221 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2222 (sreloc->contents
2223 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2224 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
2225 }
2226
2227 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
2228
2229 static void
mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_offset,unsigned char * tls_type_p,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma value)2230 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2231 unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2232 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2233 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2234 bfd_vma value)
2235 {
2236 int indx;
2237 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2238 bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2239 bfd *dynobj;
2240 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2241
2242 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2243 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2244
2245 indx = 0;
2246 if (h != NULL)
2247 {
2248 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2249
2250 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2251 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2252 indx = h->root.dynindx;
2253 }
2254
2255 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2256 return;
2257
2258 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2259 && (h == NULL
2260 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2261 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2262 need_relocs = TRUE;
2263
2264 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
2265 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2266 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
2267 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2268 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2269
2270 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
2271 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2272
2273 /* General Dynamic. */
2274 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2275 {
2276 offset = got_offset;
2277 offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2278
2279 if (need_relocs)
2280 {
2281 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2282 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2283 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2284 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2285
2286 if (indx)
2287 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2288 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2289 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2290 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2291 else
2292 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2293 sgot->contents + offset2);
2294 }
2295 else
2296 {
2297 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2298 sgot->contents + offset);
2299 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2300 sgot->contents + offset2);
2301 }
2302
2303 got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2304 }
2305
2306 /* Initial Exec model. */
2307 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2308 {
2309 offset = got_offset;
2310
2311 if (need_relocs)
2312 {
2313 if (indx == 0)
2314 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2315 sgot->contents + offset);
2316 else
2317 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2318 sgot->contents + offset);
2319
2320 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2321 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2322 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2323 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2324 }
2325 else
2326 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2327 sgot->contents + offset);
2328 }
2329
2330 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2331 {
2332 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2333 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
2334 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2335 sgot->contents + got_offset
2336 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2337
2338 if (!info->shared)
2339 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2340 sgot->contents + got_offset);
2341 else
2342 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2343 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2344 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2345 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2346 }
2347
2348 *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2349 }
2350
2351 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2352 a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models. The GOT entries for this
2353 symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX. This function initializes the
2354 GOT entries and corresponding relocations. */
2355
2356 static bfd_vma
mips_tls_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_index,unsigned char * tls_type,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma symbol)2357 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2358 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2359 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2360 {
2361 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2362 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2363
2364 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2365
2366 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2367 {
2368 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2369 if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2370 return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2371 else
2372 return got_index;
2373 }
2374
2375 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2376 {
2377 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2378 return got_index;
2379 }
2380
2381 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2382 {
2383 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
2384 return got_index;
2385 }
2386
2387 return got_index;
2388 }
2389
2390 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
2391 for global symbol H. .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
2392 will be negative. */
2393
2394 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_gotplt_index(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2395 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2396 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2397 {
2398 bfd_vma plt_index, got_address, got_value;
2399 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2400
2401 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2402 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1);
2403
2404 /* Calculate the index of the symbol's PLT entry. */
2405 plt_index = (h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size) / htab->plt_entry_size;
2406
2407 /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry. */
2408 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
2409 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
2410 + plt_index * 4);
2411
2412 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
2413 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
2414 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2415 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
2416
2417 return got_address - got_value;
2418 }
2419
2420 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE. If there is not yet a GOT
2421 entry for this value, create one. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
2422 create a TLS GOT entry instead. Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
2423 offset can be found. */
2424
2425 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_local_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2426 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2427 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
2428 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
2429 {
2430 asection *sgot;
2431 struct mips_got_info *g;
2432 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2433
2434 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2435
2436 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2437 value, r_symndx, h, r_type);
2438 if (!entry)
2439 return MINUS_ONE;
2440
2441 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2442 {
2443 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
2444 /* A type (3) entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
2445 hash table entry to track the index. */
2446 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, h->tls_got_offset, &h->tls_type,
2447 r_type, info, h, value);
2448 else
2449 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type,
2450 r_type, info, h, value);
2451 }
2452 else
2453 return entry->gotidx;
2454 }
2455
2456 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
2457
2458 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_global_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info)2459 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2460 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2461 {
2462 bfd_vma index;
2463 asection *sgot;
2464 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
2465 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
2466
2467 gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
2468 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
2469 {
2470 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
2471
2472 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
2473
2474 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2475 if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2476 {
2477 e.abfd = ibfd;
2478 e.symndx = -1;
2479 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
2480 e.tls_type = 0;
2481
2482 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
2483
2484 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
2485
2486 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2487 {
2488 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2489 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2490 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2491 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2492 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2493 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2494 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2495
2496 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
2497 info, e.d.h, value);
2498 }
2499 else
2500 return p->gotidx;
2501 }
2502 }
2503
2504 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
2505 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
2506
2507 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2508 {
2509 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2510 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2511 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2512
2513 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2514 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2515 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2516 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2517 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2518 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2519
2520 index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
2521 r_type, info, hm, value);
2522 }
2523 else
2524 {
2525 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
2526 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
2527 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
2528 offset. */
2529 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
2530 index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
2531 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2532 }
2533 BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->size);
2534
2535 return index;
2536 }
2537
2538 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE. These
2539 entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
2540 within 32KB of GP. Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
2541 entry could be created. If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
2542 offset of the GOT entry from VALUE. */
2543
2544 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_page(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_vma * offsetp)2545 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2546 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
2547 {
2548 asection *sgot;
2549 struct mips_got_info *g;
2550 bfd_vma page, index;
2551 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2552
2553 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2554
2555 page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
2556 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2557 page, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
2558
2559 if (!entry)
2560 return MINUS_ONE;
2561
2562 index = entry->gotidx;
2563
2564 if (offsetp)
2565 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
2566
2567 return index;
2568 }
2569
2570 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
2571 EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was against a global symbol
2572 that has been forced local. */
2573
2574 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got16_entry(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_boolean external)2575 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2576 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
2577 {
2578 asection *sgot;
2579 struct mips_got_info *g;
2580 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2581
2582 /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
2583 relocation; those against global symbols are not. Thus if the
2584 symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
2585 equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself. */
2586 if (! external)
2587 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
2588
2589 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2590
2591 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2592 value, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
2593 if (entry)
2594 return entry->gotidx;
2595 else
2596 return MINUS_ONE;
2597 }
2598
2599 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
2600 in the GOT. */
2601
2602 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_offset_from_index(bfd * dynobj,bfd * output_bfd,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_vma index)2603 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
2604 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
2605 {
2606 asection *sgot;
2607 bfd_vma gp;
2608 struct mips_got_info *g;
2609
2610 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
2611 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
2612 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
2613
2614 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
2615 }
2616
2617 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
2618 from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON. Return NULL if it could not
2619 be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
2620 instead. */
2621
2622 static struct mips_got_entry *
mips_elf_create_local_got_entry(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * ibfd,struct mips_got_info * gg,asection * sgot,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2623 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2624 bfd *ibfd, struct mips_got_info *gg,
2625 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value,
2626 unsigned long r_symndx,
2627 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2628 int r_type)
2629 {
2630 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2631 struct mips_got_info *g;
2632 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2633
2634 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2635
2636 entry.abfd = NULL;
2637 entry.symndx = -1;
2638 entry.d.address = value;
2639 entry.tls_type = 0;
2640
2641 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2642 if (g == NULL)
2643 {
2644 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2645 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2646 }
2647
2648 /* We might have a symbol, H, if it has been forced local. Use the
2649 global entry then. It doesn't matter whether an entry is local
2650 or global for TLS, since the dynamic linker does not
2651 automatically relocate TLS GOT entries. */
2652 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->root.forced_local);
2653 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2654 {
2655 struct mips_got_entry *p;
2656
2657 entry.abfd = ibfd;
2658 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2659 {
2660 entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
2661 entry.symndx = 0;
2662 entry.d.addend = 0;
2663 }
2664 else if (h == NULL)
2665 {
2666 entry.symndx = r_symndx;
2667 entry.d.addend = 0;
2668 }
2669 else
2670 entry.d.h = h;
2671
2672 p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
2673 htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
2674
2675 BFD_ASSERT (p);
2676 return p;
2677 }
2678
2679 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2680 INSERT);
2681 if (*loc)
2682 return *loc;
2683
2684 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2685 entry.tls_type = 0;
2686
2687 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2688
2689 if (! *loc)
2690 return NULL;
2691
2692 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2693
2694 if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
2695 {
2696 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2697 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
2698 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2699 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2700 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2701 return NULL;
2702 }
2703
2704 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2705 (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2706
2707 /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks. */
2708 if (htab->is_vxworks)
2709 {
2710 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2711 asection *s;
2712 bfd_byte *loc;
2713 bfd_vma got_address;
2714
2715 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2716 got_address = (sgot->output_section->vma
2717 + sgot->output_offset
2718 + entry.gotidx);
2719
2720 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2721 outrel.r_offset = got_address;
2722 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
2723 outrel.r_addend = value;
2724 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
2725 }
2726
2727 return *loc;
2728 }
2729
2730 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2731 appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space
2732 required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2733 known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During
2734 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the
2735 section symbols are added and the count is higher. */
2736
2737 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned long max_local)2738 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2739 {
2740 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2741 struct mips_got_info *g;
2742 bfd *dynobj;
2743
2744 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2745
2746 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2747
2748 hsd.low = NULL;
2749 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2750 hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2751 /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2752 indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2753 primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2754 dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't
2755 referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2756 don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2757 too large offsets. */
2758 - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2759 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2760 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2761 elf_hash_table (info)),
2762 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2763 &hsd);
2764
2765 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2766 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
2767 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2768 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2769 <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2770
2771 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2772 table index in the GOT. */
2773 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2774
2775 return TRUE;
2776 }
2777
2778 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2779 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2780 index. */
2781
2782 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)2783 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2784 {
2785 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2786
2787 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2788 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2789
2790 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2791 at all. */
2792 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2793 return TRUE;
2794
2795 /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2796 referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are
2797 referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2798 -1. */
2799 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2800 {
2801 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2802
2803 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2804 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2805 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2806 }
2807 else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
2808 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2809 else
2810 {
2811 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2812
2813 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2814 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2815 }
2816
2817 return TRUE;
2818 }
2819
2820 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2821 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2822 posterity. */
2823
2824 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2825 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2826 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2827 struct mips_got_info *g,
2828 unsigned char tls_flag)
2829 {
2830 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2831
2832 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2833 table. */
2834 if (h->dynindx == -1)
2835 {
2836 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2837 {
2838 case STV_INTERNAL:
2839 case STV_HIDDEN:
2840 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2841 break;
2842 }
2843 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2844 return FALSE;
2845 }
2846
2847 /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into. */
2848 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2849
2850 entry.abfd = abfd;
2851 entry.symndx = -1;
2852 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2853 entry.tls_type = 0;
2854
2855 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2856 INSERT);
2857
2858 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2859 need to do it again. */
2860 if (*loc)
2861 {
2862 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2863 return TRUE;
2864 }
2865
2866 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2867
2868 if (! *loc)
2869 return FALSE;
2870
2871 entry.gotidx = -1;
2872 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2873
2874 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2875
2876 if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2877 return TRUE;
2878
2879 /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2880 there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the
2881 generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */
2882 if (tls_flag == 0)
2883 h->got.offset = 1;
2884
2885 return TRUE;
2886 }
2887
2888 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2889 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
2890
2891 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol(bfd * abfd,long symndx,bfd_vma addend,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2892 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2893 struct mips_got_info *g,
2894 unsigned char tls_flag)
2895 {
2896 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2897
2898 entry.abfd = abfd;
2899 entry.symndx = symndx;
2900 entry.d.addend = addend;
2901 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2902 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2903 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2904
2905 if (*loc)
2906 {
2907 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
2908 {
2909 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2910 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2911 }
2912 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
2913 {
2914 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2915 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2916 }
2917 return TRUE;
2918 }
2919
2920 if (tls_flag != 0)
2921 {
2922 entry.gotidx = -1;
2923 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2924 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
2925 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2926 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
2927 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2928 else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
2929 {
2930 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
2931 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2932 }
2933 }
2934 else
2935 {
2936 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2937 entry.tls_type = 0;
2938 }
2939
2940 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2941
2942 if (! *loc)
2943 return FALSE;
2944
2945 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2946
2947 return TRUE;
2948 }
2949
2950 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
2951
2952 static hashval_t
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2953 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2954 {
2955 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
2956 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
2957
2958 return entry->bfd->id;
2959 }
2960
2961 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
2962
2963 static int
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2964 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2965 {
2966 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
2967 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
2968 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
2969 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
2970
2971 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
2972 }
2973
2974 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD. G must
2975 be the master GOT data. */
2976
2977 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_for_ibfd(struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)2978 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2979 {
2980 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
2981
2982 if (! g->bfd2got)
2983 return g;
2984
2985 e.bfd = ibfd;
2986 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
2987 return p ? p->g : NULL;
2988 }
2989
2990 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
2991 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
2992 bfd requires. */
2993
2994 static int
mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd(void ** entryp,void * p)2995 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
2996 {
2997 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2998 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2999 htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
3000 struct mips_got_info *g;
3001 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
3002 void **bfdgotp;
3003
3004 /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd. Create one if
3005 none exists. */
3006 bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
3007 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
3008 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
3009
3010 if (bfdgot != NULL)
3011 g = bfdgot->g;
3012 else
3013 {
3014 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3015 (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3016
3017 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3018 {
3019 arg->obfd = 0;
3020 return 0;
3021 }
3022
3023 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3024
3025 bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
3026 bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
3027 bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3028 if (g == NULL)
3029 {
3030 arg->obfd = 0;
3031 return 0;
3032 }
3033
3034 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3035 g->global_gotno = 0;
3036 g->local_gotno = 0;
3037 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
3038 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3039 g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3040 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3041 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3042 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3043 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3044 {
3045 arg->obfd = 0;
3046 return 0;
3047 }
3048
3049 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3050 g->next = NULL;
3051 }
3052
3053 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
3054 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3055 if (*entryp != NULL)
3056 return 1;
3057
3058 *entryp = entry;
3059
3060 if (entry->tls_type)
3061 {
3062 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3063 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3064 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3065 g->tls_gotno += 1;
3066 }
3067 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
3068 ++g->local_gotno;
3069 else
3070 ++g->global_gotno;
3071
3072 return 1;
3073 }
3074
3075 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
3076 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
3077 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
3078 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
3079 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
3080 and then make make the new got current. */
3081
3082 static int
mips_elf_merge_gots(void ** bfd2got_,void * p)3083 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
3084 {
3085 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
3086 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
3087 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
3088 unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
3089 unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
3090 unsigned int tcount = bfd2got->g->tls_gotno;
3091 unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
3092 bfd_boolean too_many_for_tls = FALSE;
3093
3094 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
3095 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
3096 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
3097 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
3098 if (tcount > 0)
3099 {
3100 unsigned int primary_total = lcount + tcount + arg->global_count;
3101 if (primary_total > maxcnt)
3102 too_many_for_tls = TRUE;
3103 }
3104
3105 /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
3106 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
3107 if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt
3108 && ! too_many_for_tls)
3109 {
3110 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
3111 arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
3112 }
3113 /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
3114 the primary, merge them. The heuristics is conservative, but we
3115 don't have to squeeze it too hard. */
3116 else if (arg->primary && ! too_many_for_tls
3117 && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount + tcount) <= maxcnt)
3118 {
3119 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3120 int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
3121 int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
3122 int old_tcount = arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3123
3124 bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
3125
3126 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3127 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3128 arg);
3129 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3130 return 0;
3131
3132 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3133 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
3134 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
3135 table anyway. */
3136
3137 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
3138 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
3139 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->primary->tls_gotno);
3140
3141 arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
3142 + arg->primary->global_gotno + arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3143 }
3144 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
3145 else if (arg->current
3146 && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt)
3147 {
3148 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3149 int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
3150 int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
3151 int old_tcount = arg->current->tls_gotno;
3152
3153 bfd2got->g = arg->current;
3154
3155 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3156 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3157 arg);
3158 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3159 return 0;
3160
3161 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3162
3163 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
3164 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
3165 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->current->tls_gotno);
3166
3167 arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
3168 + arg->current->global_gotno + arg->current->tls_gotno;
3169 }
3170 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
3171 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
3172 overflows anyway. */
3173 else
3174 {
3175 bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
3176 arg->current = bfd2got->g;
3177
3178 arg->current_count = lcount + gcount + 2 * tcount;
3179 }
3180
3181 return 1;
3182 }
3183
3184 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. ENTRYP's NEXT field
3185 is null iff there is just a single GOT. */
3186
3187 static int
mips_elf_initialize_tls_index(void ** entryp,void * p)3188 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
3189 {
3190 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3191 struct mips_got_info *g = p;
3192 bfd_vma next_index;
3193 unsigned char tls_type;
3194
3195 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
3196 if (entry->tls_type == 0)
3197 return 1;
3198
3199 next_index = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
3200
3201 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
3202 {
3203 /* A type (3) got entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
3204 hash table entry to track its index. */
3205 if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
3206 return 1;
3207 entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
3208 entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = next_index;
3209 tls_type = entry->d.h->tls_type;
3210 }
3211 else
3212 {
3213 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3214 {
3215 /* There are separate mips_got_entry objects for each input bfd
3216 that requires an LDM entry. Make sure that all LDM entries in
3217 a GOT resolve to the same index. */
3218 if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
3219 {
3220 entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
3221 return 1;
3222 }
3223 g->tls_ldm_offset = next_index;
3224 }
3225 entry->gotidx = next_index;
3226 tls_type = entry->tls_type;
3227 }
3228
3229 /* Account for the entries we've just allocated. */
3230 if (tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3231 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
3232 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3233 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
3234
3235 return 1;
3236 }
3237
3238 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
3239 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
3240 got) to the given VALUE.
3241
3242 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
3243 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
3244 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
3245 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
3246 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
3247 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
3248 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
3249 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
3250 stub. */
3251 static int
mips_elf_set_global_got_offset(void ** entryp,void * p)3252 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
3253 {
3254 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3255 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
3256 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
3257 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
3258
3259 if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
3260 arg->needed_relocs +=
3261 mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
3262 entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3263
3264 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
3265 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1
3266 && entry->d.h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
3267 {
3268 if (g)
3269 {
3270 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
3271
3272 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
3273 if (arg->info->shared
3274 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
3275 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
3276 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
3277 ++arg->needed_relocs;
3278 }
3279 else
3280 entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
3281 }
3282
3283 return 1;
3284 }
3285
3286 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
3287 as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */
3288 static int
mips_elf_set_no_stub(void ** entryp,void * p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3289 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3290 {
3291 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3292
3293 if (entry->abfd != NULL
3294 && entry->symndx == -1
3295 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
3296 entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
3297
3298 return 1;
3299 }
3300
3301 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
3302 points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer
3303 to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may
3304 modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
3305 we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
3306 the traversal must be restarted. */
3307 static int
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry(void ** entryp,void * p)3308 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
3309 {
3310 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3311 htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
3312
3313 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3314 {
3315 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
3316
3317 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3318 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3319 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3320
3321 if (entry->d.h == h)
3322 return 1;
3323
3324 entry->d.h = h;
3325
3326 /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
3327 it, and get the traversal restarted. */
3328 if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
3329 {
3330 htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
3331 entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3332 if (! *entryp)
3333 *entryp = entry;
3334 /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
3335 moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
3336 process. */
3337 *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
3338 return 0;
3339 }
3340 /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
3341 either too early or too late for that at this point. */
3342 }
3343
3344 return 1;
3345 }
3346
3347 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
3348 locations. */
3349 static void
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries(struct mips_got_info * g)3350 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3351 {
3352 htab_t got_entries;
3353
3354 do
3355 {
3356 got_entries = g->got_entries;
3357
3358 htab_traverse (got_entries,
3359 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
3360 &got_entries);
3361 }
3362 while (got_entries == NULL);
3363 }
3364
3365 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
3366 the primary GOT. */
3367 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_adjust_gp(bfd * abfd,struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)3368 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3369 {
3370 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3371 return 0;
3372
3373 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3374 if (! g)
3375 return 0;
3376
3377 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
3378
3379 g = g->next;
3380
3381 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
3382 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3383 }
3384
3385 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
3386 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
3387
3388 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_multi_got(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,asection * got,bfd_size_type pages)3389 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3390 struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
3391 bfd_size_type pages)
3392 {
3393 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
3394 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
3395 struct mips_got_info *gg;
3396 unsigned int assign;
3397
3398 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
3399 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
3400 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3401 return FALSE;
3402
3403 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
3404 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
3405 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
3406
3407 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
3408 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
3409 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3410 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3411 return FALSE;
3412
3413 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
3414 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
3415 /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate. We could
3416 compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
3417 uses, but it's probably not worth it. */
3418 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
3419 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
3420 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info) - pages);
3421 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
3422 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
3423 information. */
3424 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
3425
3426 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
3427 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
3428 to be the primary GOT. */
3429 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3430 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3431 return FALSE;
3432
3433 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
3434 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
3435 {
3436 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
3437 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3438 if (g->next == NULL)
3439 return FALSE;
3440
3441 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
3442 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
3443 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
3444 g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
3445 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
3446 g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3447 g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3448 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3449 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
3450 NULL);
3451 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
3452 return FALSE;
3453 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
3454 }
3455 else
3456 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
3457 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
3458
3459 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
3460 gg = g;
3461 g = g->next;
3462
3463 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
3464 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
3465 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
3466 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
3467 list. */
3468 {
3469 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
3470 void **bfdgotp;
3471
3472 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3473 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3474
3475 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3476 return FALSE;
3477
3478 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
3479 bfdgot->g = g;
3480 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
3481
3482 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
3483 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3484 }
3485
3486 /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
3487 in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
3488 arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
3489 referenced.
3490
3491 GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
3492 the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
3493 symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
3494 the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
3495 helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
3496 follows IRIX's practice.
3497
3498 The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
3499 global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
3500 an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
3501 the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
3502 preserved. */
3503 if (1)
3504 {
3505 gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
3506 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
3507 set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
3508 }
3509 else
3510 {
3511 /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
3512 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
3513 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
3514 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
3515 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
3516 their entries can be omitted. */
3517 gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
3518 set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
3519 }
3520
3521 /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
3522 depends on the setting of VALUE). */
3523 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
3524 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3525 &set_got_offset_arg);
3526 set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
3527 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3528 &set_got_offset_arg);
3529 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
3530 return FALSE;
3531
3532 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
3533 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
3534 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
3535 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
3536 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
3537 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
3538 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
3539 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
3540 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
3541 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
3542 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
3543 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
3544 points back to the master GOT. */
3545 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
3546 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
3547 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
3548 assign = 0;
3549 gg->next = gg;
3550
3551 do
3552 {
3553 struct mips_got_info *gn;
3554
3555 assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3556 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
3557 g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
3558 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3559
3560 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
3561 list that gg points to. g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
3562 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
3563 gn = g->next;
3564 g->next = gg->next;
3565 gg->next = g;
3566
3567 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
3568 all non-TLS entries. */
3569 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
3570 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
3571
3572 /* Move onto the next GOT. It will be a secondary GOT if nonull. */
3573 g = gn;
3574
3575 /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
3576 stubs. */
3577 if (g)
3578 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
3579 }
3580 while (g);
3581
3582 got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
3583 + gg->next->global_gotno
3584 + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3585
3586 return TRUE;
3587 }
3588
3589
3590 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
3591 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
3592
3593 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
mips_elf_next_relocation(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int r_type,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relend)3594 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
3595 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3596 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
3597 {
3598 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
3599
3600 while (relocation < relend)
3601 {
3602 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
3603 && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
3604 return relocation;
3605
3606 ++relocation;
3607 }
3608
3609 /* We didn't find it. */
3610 return NULL;
3611 }
3612
3613 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */
3614
3615 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_local_relocation_p(bfd * input_bfd,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,asection ** local_sections,bfd_boolean check_forced)3616 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
3617 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3618 asection **local_sections,
3619 bfd_boolean check_forced)
3620 {
3621 unsigned long r_symndx;
3622 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3623 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3624 size_t extsymoff;
3625
3626 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3627 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3628 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3629
3630 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
3631 return TRUE;
3632 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
3633 return TRUE;
3634
3635 if (check_forced)
3636 {
3637 /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
3638 was forced local. */
3639 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3640 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
3641 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3642 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3643 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3644 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3645 if (h->root.forced_local)
3646 return TRUE;
3647 }
3648
3649 return FALSE;
3650 }
3651
3652 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
3653
3654 bfd_vma
_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend(bfd_vma value,int bits)3655 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3656 {
3657 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
3658 /* VALUE is negative. */
3659 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
3660
3661 return value;
3662 }
3663
3664 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
3665 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
3666 BITS. */
3667
3668 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_overflow_p(bfd_vma value,int bits)3669 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3670 {
3671 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
3672
3673 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
3674 /* The value is too big. */
3675 return TRUE;
3676 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
3677 /* The value is too small. */
3678 return TRUE;
3679
3680 /* All is well. */
3681 return FALSE;
3682 }
3683
3684 /* Calculate the %high function. */
3685
3686 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_high(bfd_vma value)3687 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
3688 {
3689 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
3690 }
3691
3692 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
3693
3694 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_higher(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3695 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3696 {
3697 #ifdef BFD64
3698 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
3699 #else
3700 abort ();
3701 return MINUS_ONE;
3702 #endif
3703 }
3704
3705 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
3706
3707 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_highest(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3708 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3709 {
3710 #ifdef BFD64
3711 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
3712 #else
3713 abort ();
3714 return MINUS_ONE;
3715 #endif
3716 }
3717
3718 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
3719
3720 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3721 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
3722 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3723 {
3724 flagword flags;
3725 register asection *s;
3726
3727 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
3728 {
3729 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3730 | SEC_READONLY);
3731
3732 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
3733 if (s == NULL
3734 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
3735 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
3736 return FALSE;
3737
3738 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
3739 }
3740
3741 return TRUE;
3742 }
3743
3744 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
3745
3746 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_got_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)3747 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3748 bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
3749 {
3750 flagword flags;
3751 register asection *s;
3752 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3753 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
3754 struct mips_got_info *g;
3755 bfd_size_type amt;
3756 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3757
3758 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3759
3760 /* This function may be called more than once. */
3761 s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
3762 if (s)
3763 {
3764 if (! maybe_exclude)
3765 s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
3766 return TRUE;
3767 }
3768
3769 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3770 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3771
3772 if (maybe_exclude)
3773 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3774
3775 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
3776 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
3777 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3778 if (s == NULL
3779 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3780 return FALSE;
3781
3782 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
3783 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
3784 are not creating a global offset table. */
3785 bh = NULL;
3786 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
3787 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
3788 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
3789 return FALSE;
3790
3791 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
3792 h->non_elf = 0;
3793 h->def_regular = 1;
3794 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
3795 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
3796
3797 if (info->shared
3798 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3799 return FALSE;
3800
3801 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
3802 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
3803 if (g == NULL)
3804 return FALSE;
3805 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3806 g->global_gotno = 0;
3807 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3808 g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3809 g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3810 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3811 g->next = NULL;
3812 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3813 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3814 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3815 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3816 return FALSE;
3817 mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
3818 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
3819 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
3820
3821 /* VxWorks also needs a .got.plt section. */
3822 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3823 {
3824 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
3825 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3826 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3827 if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3828 return FALSE;
3829
3830 htab->sgotplt = s;
3831 }
3832 return TRUE;
3833 }
3834
3835 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
3836 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols. These symbols are only special for
3837 shared objects; they are not used in executables. */
3838
3839 static bfd_boolean
is_gott_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)3840 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3841 {
3842 return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
3843 && info->shared
3844 && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
3845 || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
3846 }
3847
3848 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
3849 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
3850 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
3851
3852 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
3853 REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
3854 relocation must be JALX.
3855
3856 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
3857 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
3858 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
3859 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
3860
3861 static bfd_reloc_status_type
mips_elf_calculate_relocation(bfd * abfd,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma addend,reloc_howto_type * howto,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,bfd_vma * valuep,const char ** namep,bfd_boolean * require_jalxp,bfd_boolean save_addend)3862 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
3863 asection *input_section,
3864 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3865 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3866 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
3867 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
3868 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
3869 const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
3870 bfd_boolean save_addend)
3871 {
3872 /* The eventual value we will return. */
3873 bfd_vma value;
3874 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
3875 occurring. */
3876 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
3877 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
3878 shared object file being produced. */
3879 bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
3880 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
3881 relocated. */
3882 bfd_vma p;
3883 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
3884 bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
3885 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
3886 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
3887 during execution. */
3888 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
3889 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
3890 located. */
3891 asection *sec = NULL;
3892 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
3893 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
3894 symbol. */
3895 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
3896 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
3897 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
3898 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
3899 "__gnu_local_gp". */
3900 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
3901 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3902 size_t extsymoff;
3903 unsigned long r_symndx;
3904 int r_type;
3905 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
3906 relocation value. */
3907 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
3908 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
3909 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
3910 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3911 bfd *dynobj;
3912
3913 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3914 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3915
3916 /* Parse the relocation. */
3917 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3918 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3919 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
3920 + input_section->output_offset
3921 + relocation->r_offset);
3922
3923 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
3924 overflowed_p = FALSE;
3925
3926 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
3927 used in the array of hash table entries. */
3928 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3929 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3930 local_sections, FALSE);
3931 was_local_p = local_p;
3932 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
3933 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3934 else
3935 {
3936 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
3937 must come before globals. */
3938 extsymoff = 0;
3939 }
3940
3941 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
3942 if (local_p)
3943 {
3944 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
3945
3946 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
3947 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
3948
3949 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3950 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
3951 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
3952 symbol += sym->st_value;
3953 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
3954 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
3955 {
3956 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
3957 addend -= symbol;
3958 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3959 }
3960
3961 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
3962 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
3963 ++symbol;
3964
3965 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3966 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
3967 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
3968 sym->st_name);
3969 if (*namep == '\0')
3970 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
3971
3972 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
3973 }
3974 else
3975 {
3976 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
3977
3978 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
3979 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3980 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
3981 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3982 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3983 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3984 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3985
3986 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3987 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
3988
3989 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
3990 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
3991 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
3992 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
3993 {
3994 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
3995 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
3996 if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16
3997 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
3998 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3999
4000 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
4001 }
4002 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
4003 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
4004 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
4005 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
4006
4007
4008 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
4009 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
4010 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
4011 its defined. */
4012 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4013 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4014 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
4015 {
4016 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4017 if (sec->output_section)
4018 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
4019 + sec->output_section->vma
4020 + sec->output_offset);
4021 else
4022 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
4023 }
4024 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4025 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
4026 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
4027 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
4028 addresses. */
4029 symbol = 0;
4030 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
4031 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
4032 symbol = 0;
4033 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
4034 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
4035 {
4036 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
4037 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
4038 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
4039 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
4040 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
4041 somehow as well. */
4042 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
4043 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
4044 symbol = 0;
4045 }
4046 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
4047 {
4048 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
4049 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
4050 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
4051 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
4052 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
4053 which is available from here:
4054 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
4055 symbol = 0;
4056 }
4057 else
4058 {
4059 if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
4060 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
4061 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
4062 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
4063 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
4064 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4065 symbol = 0;
4066 }
4067
4068 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
4069 }
4070
4071 /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
4072 need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
4073 a stub. */
4074 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4075 && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
4076 || (local_p
4077 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
4078 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4079 && !mips16_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
4080 {
4081 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
4082 have already noticed that we were going to need the
4083 stub. */
4084 if (local_p)
4085 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
4086 else
4087 {
4088 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
4089 sec = h->fn_stub;
4090 }
4091
4092 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4093 /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't. */
4094 target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
4095 }
4096 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
4097 need to redirect the call to the stub. */
4098 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4099 && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
4100 || (local_p
4101 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
4102 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4103 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4104 {
4105 if (local_p)
4106 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
4107 else
4108 {
4109 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
4110 out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
4111 file. */
4112 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
4113 {
4114 asection *o;
4115
4116 sec = NULL;
4117 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
4118 {
4119 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
4120 {
4121 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4122 break;
4123 }
4124 }
4125 if (sec == NULL)
4126 sec = h->call_stub;
4127 }
4128 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
4129 sec = h->call_stub;
4130 else
4131 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4132 }
4133
4134 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
4135 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4136 }
4137
4138 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
4139 special jalx instruction. */
4140 *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
4141 && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4142 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
4143
4144 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4145 local_sections, TRUE);
4146
4147 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
4148 and we're going to need it, get it now. */
4149 switch (r_type)
4150 {
4151 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4152 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4153 /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
4154 bind locally. */
4155 local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
4156 if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
4157 break;
4158 /* Fall through. */
4159
4160 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4161 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4162 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4163 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4164 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4165 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4166 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4167 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4168 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4169 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4170 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
4171 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
4172 {
4173 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4174 0, 0, NULL, r_type);
4175 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4176 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4177 }
4178 else if (!local_p)
4179 {
4180 /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
4181 entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub. */
4182 if (htab->is_vxworks
4183 && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16
4184 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
4185 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16))
4186 {
4187 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
4188 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
4189 g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
4190 }
4191 else
4192 {
4193 /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
4194 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
4195 symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added
4196 as GOT_OFST. */
4197 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
4198 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, input_bfd,
4199 &h->root, r_type, info);
4200 if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
4201 && (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
4202 || (info->shared
4203 && (info->symbolic || h->root.forced_local)
4204 && h->root.def_regular)))
4205 {
4206 /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The
4207 symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
4208 We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */
4209 asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
4210 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
4211 }
4212 }
4213 }
4214 else if (!htab->is_vxworks
4215 && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)))
4216 /* The calculation below does not involve "g". */
4217 break;
4218 else
4219 {
4220 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4221 symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
4222 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4223 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4224 }
4225
4226 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
4227 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, g);
4228 break;
4229
4230 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4231 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4232 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4233 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4234 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4235 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4236 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4237 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4238 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
4239 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
4240 if (dynobj)
4241 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL),
4242 input_bfd);
4243 break;
4244
4245 default:
4246 break;
4247 }
4248
4249 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
4250 symbol = gp;
4251
4252 /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
4253 symbols are resolved by the loader. Add them to .rela.dyn. */
4254 if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
4255 {
4256 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4257 bfd_byte *loc;
4258 asection *s;
4259
4260 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4261 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4262
4263 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
4264 + input_section->output_offset
4265 + relocation->r_offset);
4266 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
4267 outrel.r_addend = addend;
4268 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
4269
4270 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4271 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4272 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
4273 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4274 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4275
4276 *valuep = 0;
4277 return bfd_reloc_ok;
4278 }
4279
4280 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
4281 switch (r_type)
4282 {
4283 case R_MIPS_NONE:
4284 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4285
4286 case R_MIPS_16:
4287 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4288 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4289 break;
4290
4291 case R_MIPS_32:
4292 case R_MIPS_REL32:
4293 case R_MIPS_64:
4294 if ((info->shared
4295 || (!htab->is_vxworks
4296 && htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
4297 && h != NULL
4298 && h->root.def_dynamic
4299 && !h->root.def_regular))
4300 && r_symndx != 0
4301 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4302 {
4303 /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
4304 against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
4305 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
4306 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
4307 linker.
4308
4309 In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
4310 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
4311 no need to add a dynamic relocation here. */
4312 value = addend;
4313 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
4314 info,
4315 relocation,
4316 h,
4317 sec,
4318 symbol,
4319 &value,
4320 input_section))
4321 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4322 }
4323 else
4324 {
4325 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4326 value = symbol + addend;
4327 else
4328 value = addend;
4329 }
4330 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4331 break;
4332
4333 case R_MIPS_PC32:
4334 value = symbol + addend - p;
4335 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4336 break;
4337
4338 case R_MIPS16_26:
4339 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
4340 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
4341 the output file that's different. That's handled in
4342 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
4343 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
4344 case R_MIPS_26:
4345 if (local_p)
4346 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
4347 else
4348 {
4349 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
4350 if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4351 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
4352 }
4353 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4354 break;
4355
4356 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
4357 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
4358 & howto->dst_mask);
4359 break;
4360
4361 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
4362 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
4363 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
4364 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4365 break;
4366
4367 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
4368 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
4369 & howto->dst_mask);
4370 break;
4371
4372 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
4373 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4374 break;
4375
4376 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4377 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4378 if (!gp_disp_p)
4379 {
4380 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
4381 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4382 }
4383 else
4384 {
4385 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4386 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4387 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4388 8: sll $v0,16
4389 12: addu $v0,$v1
4390 14: move $gp,$v0
4391 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4392 $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
4393 both reloc addends by 4. */
4394 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
4395 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
4396 else
4397 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
4398 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4399 }
4400 break;
4401
4402 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4403 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4404 if (!gp_disp_p)
4405 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
4406 else
4407 {
4408 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4409 for this conditional. */
4410 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
4411 value = addend + gp - p;
4412 else
4413 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
4414 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4415 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
4416 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
4417 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
4418 this:
4419
4420 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4421 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4422 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
4423
4424 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4425 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
4426 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4427 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4428 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4429 not check for overflow here. */
4430 }
4431 break;
4432
4433 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4434 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
4435 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
4436 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
4437 here. */
4438
4439 /* Fall through. */
4440
4441 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4442 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
4443 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
4444 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
4445 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
4446 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4447 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
4448 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
4449 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
4450 if (howto->partial_inplace)
4451 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4452 value = symbol + addend - gp;
4453 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
4454 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
4455 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
4456 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
4457 to them before. */
4458 if (was_local_p)
4459 value += gp0;
4460 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4461 break;
4462
4463 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4464 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4465 /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
4466 R_MIPS_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G". */
4467 if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
4468 {
4469 bfd_boolean forced;
4470
4471 forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4472 local_sections, FALSE);
4473 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4474 symbol + addend, forced);
4475 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4476 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4477 value
4478 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4479 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4480 break;
4481 }
4482
4483 /* Fall through. */
4484
4485 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4486 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4487 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4488 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4489 got_disp:
4490 value = g;
4491 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4492 break;
4493
4494 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4495 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
4496 if (!save_addend)
4497 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4498 break;
4499
4500 case R_MIPS_PC16:
4501 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
4502 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
4503 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
4504 value >>= howto->rightshift;
4505 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4506 break;
4507
4508 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4509 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4510 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
4511 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
4512 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
4513 value = g;
4514 value = mips_elf_high (value);
4515 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4516 break;
4517
4518 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4519 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4520 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
4521 break;
4522
4523 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4524 /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
4525 to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
4526 0. */
4527 if (! local_p)
4528 goto got_disp;
4529 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
4530 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4531 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4532 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4533 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4534 break;
4535
4536 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4537 if (local_p)
4538 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
4539 else
4540 value = addend;
4541 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4542 break;
4543
4544 case R_MIPS_SUB:
4545 value = symbol - addend;
4546 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4547 break;
4548
4549 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
4550 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
4551 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4552 break;
4553
4554 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
4555 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
4556 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4557 break;
4558
4559 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
4560 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
4561 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4562 break;
4563
4564 case R_MIPS_JALR:
4565 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
4566 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
4567 branches to the PLT; that will wind up wasting time. */
4568 if (h != NULL && h->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4569 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4570 value = symbol + addend;
4571 break;
4572
4573 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
4574 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4575 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
4576 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
4577 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4578
4579 default:
4580 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
4581 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4582 }
4583
4584 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
4585 *valuep = value;
4586 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
4587 }
4588
4589 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
4590
4591 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_obtain_contents(reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_byte * contents)4592 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
4593 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4594 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
4595 {
4596 bfd_vma x;
4597 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4598
4599 /* Obtain the bytes. */
4600 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
4601
4602 return x;
4603 }
4604
4605 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
4606 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
4607 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
4608 relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
4609 for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
4610 unconditionally converted to JALX.
4611
4612 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
4613
4614 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_perform_relocation(struct bfd_link_info * info,reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma value,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,bfd_boolean require_jalx)4615 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4616 reloc_howto_type *howto,
4617 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4618 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
4619 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
4620 bfd_boolean require_jalx)
4621 {
4622 bfd_vma x;
4623 bfd_byte *location;
4624 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4625
4626 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
4627 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4628
4629 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
4630
4631 /* Obtain the current value. */
4632 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
4633
4634 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
4635 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
4636
4637 /* Set the field. */
4638 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
4639
4640 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
4641 if (require_jalx)
4642 {
4643 bfd_boolean ok;
4644 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
4645 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
4646
4647 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
4648 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
4649 {
4650 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
4651 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4652 }
4653 else
4654 {
4655 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
4656 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4657 }
4658
4659 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
4660 if (!ok)
4661 {
4662 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4663 (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
4664 input_bfd,
4665 input_section,
4666 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
4667 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4668 return FALSE;
4669 }
4670
4671 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
4672 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4673 }
4674
4675 /* On the RM9000, bal is faster than jal, because bal uses branch
4676 prediction hardware. If we are linking for the RM9000, and we
4677 see jal, and bal fits, use it instead. Note that this
4678 transformation should be safe for all architectures. */
4679 if (bfd_get_mach (input_bfd) == bfd_mach_mips9000
4680 && !info->relocatable
4681 && !require_jalx
4682 && ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
4683 || (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR && x == 0x0320f809))) /* jalr t9 */
4684 {
4685 bfd_vma addr;
4686 bfd_vma dest;
4687 bfd_signed_vma off;
4688
4689 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
4690 + input_section->output_offset
4691 + relocation->r_offset
4692 + 4);
4693 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
4694 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
4695 else
4696 dest = value;
4697 off = dest - addr;
4698 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
4699 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
4700 }
4701
4702 /* Put the value into the output. */
4703 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
4704
4705 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
4706 location);
4707
4708 return TRUE;
4709 }
4710
4711 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */
4712
4713 static bfd_boolean
mips16_stub_section_p(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * section)4714 mips16_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
4715 {
4716 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
4717
4718 return FN_STUB_P (name) || CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name);
4719 }
4720
4721 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD. */
4722
4723 static void
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned int n)4724 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4725 unsigned int n)
4726 {
4727 asection *s;
4728 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4729
4730 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4731 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4732 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4733
4734 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4735 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
4736 else
4737 {
4738 if (s->size == 0)
4739 {
4740 /* Make room for a null element. */
4741 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4742 ++s->reloc_count;
4743 }
4744 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4745 }
4746 }
4747
4748 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
4749 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
4750 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
4751 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
4752
4753 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,asection * sec,bfd_vma symbol,bfd_vma * addendp,asection * input_section)4754 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
4755 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4756 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4757 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4758 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
4759 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
4760 {
4761 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
4762 asection *sreloc;
4763 bfd *dynobj;
4764 int r_type;
4765 long indx;
4766 bfd_boolean defined_p;
4767 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4768
4769 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4770 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
4771 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4772 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4773 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
4774 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
4775 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
4776 < sreloc->size);
4777
4778 outrel[0].r_offset =
4779 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
4780 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4781 {
4782 outrel[1].r_offset =
4783 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
4784 outrel[2].r_offset =
4785 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
4786 }
4787
4788 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
4789 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
4790 return TRUE;
4791
4792 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
4793 {
4794 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
4795 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
4796 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
4797 *addendp += symbol;
4798 return TRUE;
4799 }
4800
4801 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
4802 in the relocation. */
4803 if (h != NULL
4804 && (!h->root.def_regular
4805 || (info->shared && !info->symbolic && !h->root.forced_local)))
4806 {
4807 indx = h->root.dynindx;
4808 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4809 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
4810 else
4811 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
4812 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
4813 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
4814 undefined symbols. */
4815 defined_p = FALSE;
4816 }
4817 else
4818 {
4819 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
4820 indx = 0;
4821 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
4822 {
4823 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4824 return FALSE;
4825 }
4826 else
4827 {
4828 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
4829 if (indx == 0)
4830 {
4831 asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
4832 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
4833 }
4834 if (indx == 0)
4835 abort ();
4836 }
4837
4838 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
4839 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
4840 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
4841 local symbols because we used to generate them
4842 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
4843 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
4844 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
4845 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
4846 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
4847 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
4848 as well. */
4849 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
4850 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
4851 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
4852 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
4853 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4854 indx = 0;
4855 defined_p = TRUE;
4856 }
4857
4858 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
4859 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
4860 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
4861 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
4862 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4863 *addendp += symbol;
4864
4865 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4866 /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this. */
4867 outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
4868 else
4869 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
4870 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
4871 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
4872 R_MIPS_REL32);
4873
4874 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
4875 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
4876 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
4877 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
4878 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
4879 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
4880 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
4881 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
4882 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
4883 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
4884 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
4885 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
4886 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
4887 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
4888 ? R_MIPS_64
4889 : R_MIPS_NONE);
4890 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
4891
4892 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
4893 correct location in the output file. */
4894 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4895 + input_section->output_offset);
4896 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4897 + input_section->output_offset);
4898 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4899 + input_section->output_offset);
4900
4901 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
4902 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
4903 relocation format is non-standard. */
4904 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4905 {
4906 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
4907 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4908 (sreloc->contents
4909 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
4910 }
4911 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
4912 {
4913 /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations. */
4914 outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
4915 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
4916 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4917 (sreloc->contents
4918 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
4919 }
4920 else
4921 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
4922 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4923 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
4924
4925 /* We've now added another relocation. */
4926 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
4927
4928 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
4929 will be writing to it. */
4930 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
4931 |= SHF_WRITE;
4932
4933 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
4934 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
4935 {
4936 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
4937 bfd_byte *cr;
4938
4939 if (scpt)
4940 {
4941 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
4942
4943 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
4944 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
4945 + input_section->output_section->vma
4946 + input_section->output_offset);
4947 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
4948 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
4949 else
4950 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
4951 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
4952 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
4953
4954 cr = (scpt->contents
4955 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
4956 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
4957 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
4958 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
4959 + scpt->reloc_count));
4960 ++scpt->reloc_count;
4961 }
4962 }
4963
4964 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4965 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4966 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
4967 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4968 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4969
4970 return TRUE;
4971 }
4972
4973 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
4974
4975 unsigned long
_bfd_elf_mips_mach(flagword flags)4976 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
4977 {
4978 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
4979 {
4980 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
4981 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
4982
4983 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
4984 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
4985
4986 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
4987 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
4988
4989 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
4990 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
4991
4992 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
4993 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
4994
4995 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
4996 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
4997
4998 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
4999 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
5000
5001 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
5002 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
5003
5004 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
5005 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
5006
5007 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
5008 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
5009
5010 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
5011 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
5012
5013 default:
5014 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
5015 {
5016 default:
5017 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
5018 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
5019
5020 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
5021 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
5022
5023 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
5024 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
5025
5026 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
5027 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
5028
5029 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
5030 return bfd_mach_mips5;
5031
5032 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
5033 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
5034
5035 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
5036 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
5037
5038 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
5039 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
5040
5041 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
5042 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
5043 }
5044 }
5045
5046 return 0;
5047 }
5048
5049 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
5050
5051 static INLINE char *
elf_mips_abi_name(bfd * abfd)5052 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
5053 {
5054 flagword flags;
5055
5056 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
5057 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
5058 {
5059 case 0:
5060 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
5061 return "N32";
5062 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
5063 return "64";
5064 else
5065 return "none";
5066 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
5067 return "O32";
5068 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
5069 return "O64";
5070 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
5071 return "EABI32";
5072 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
5073 return "EABI64";
5074 default:
5075 return "unknown abi";
5076 }
5077 }
5078
5079 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
5080 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
5081 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
5082 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
5083 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
5084 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
5085 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5086 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5087
5088 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
5089 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
5090 definition in a shared library. */
5091 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
5092 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5093 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5094
5095 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
5096 This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5097
5098 void
_bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing(bfd * abfd,asymbol * asym)5099 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
5100 {
5101 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
5102
5103 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
5104 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
5105 {
5106 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5107 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
5108 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
5109 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
5110 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
5111 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
5112 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
5113 {
5114 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
5115 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
5116 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
5117 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5118 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5119 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5120 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
5121 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5122 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5123 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5124 }
5125 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5126 break;
5127
5128 case SHN_COMMON:
5129 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5130 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
5131 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5132 || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
5133 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5134 break;
5135 /* Fall through. */
5136 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5137 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
5138 {
5139 /* Initialize the small common section. */
5140 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
5141 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
5142 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5143 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5144 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5145 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
5146 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5147 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5148 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5149 }
5150 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5151 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5152 break;
5153
5154 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5155 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5156 break;
5157
5158 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5159 {
5160 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
5161
5162 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5163 if (section != NULL)
5164 {
5165 asym->section = section;
5166 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5167 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
5168 base address to make it an offset. */
5169 asym->value -= section->vma;
5170 }
5171 }
5172 break;
5173
5174 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5175 {
5176 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
5177
5178 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5179 if (section != NULL)
5180 {
5181 asym->section = section;
5182 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5183 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
5184 base address to make it an offset. */
5185 asym->value -= section->vma;
5186 }
5187 }
5188 break;
5189 }
5190 }
5191
5192 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
5193 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
5194
5195 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
5196 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
5197 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
5198 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
5199 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
5200
5201 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
5202 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
5203 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
5204 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
5205
5206 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
5207 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
5208 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
5209 We therefore take the following approach:
5210
5211 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
5212 determine the pointer size.
5213
5214 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
5215 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
5216
5217 - Otherwise punt.
5218
5219 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
5220 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
5221 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
5222 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
5223 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
5224
5225 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
5226 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
5227 did so. */
5228
5229 unsigned int
_bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)5230 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
5231 {
5232 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
5233 return 8;
5234 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
5235 {
5236 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
5237
5238 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
5239 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
5240 if (long32_p && long64_p)
5241 return 0;
5242 if (long32_p)
5243 return 4;
5244 if (long64_p)
5245 return 8;
5246
5247 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
5248 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
5249 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
5250 == R_MIPS_64))
5251 return 8;
5252
5253 return 0;
5254 }
5255 return 4;
5256 }
5257
5258 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
5259 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
5260 same address. For example, if we have code like:
5261
5262 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
5263 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
5264 jalr $25
5265
5266 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
5267 will jump there rather than to .text.
5268
5269 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
5270 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
5271
5272 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols(bfd * abfd)5273 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
5274 {
5275 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
5276 }
5277
5278 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
5279 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
5280 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
5281 a better way. */
5282
5283 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_processing(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr)5284 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
5285 {
5286 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
5287 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
5288 {
5289 bfd_byte buf[4];
5290
5291 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
5292 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
5293
5294 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5295 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
5296 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5297 return FALSE;
5298 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5299 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5300 return FALSE;
5301 }
5302
5303 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
5304 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5305 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
5306 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
5307 {
5308 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5309
5310 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
5311 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
5312 so that we don't have to read them again.
5313 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
5314 through the section contents to see if there is an
5315 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
5316
5317 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
5318 l = contents;
5319 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5320 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5321 {
5322 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5323
5324 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5325 &intopt);
5326 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5327 {
5328 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5329 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5330 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5331 break;
5332 }
5333 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5334 {
5335 bfd_byte buf[8];
5336
5337 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5338 (hdr->sh_offset
5339 + (l - contents)
5340 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5341 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
5342 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5343 return FALSE;
5344 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5345 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
5346 return FALSE;
5347 }
5348 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5349 {
5350 bfd_byte buf[4];
5351
5352 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5353 (hdr->sh_offset
5354 + (l - contents)
5355 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5356 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
5357 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5358 return FALSE;
5359 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5360 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5361 return FALSE;
5362 }
5363 l += intopt.size;
5364 }
5365 }
5366
5367 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
5368 {
5369 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
5370
5371 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5372 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
5373 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
5374 {
5375 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5376 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5377 }
5378 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
5379 {
5380 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5381 hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
5382 }
5383 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
5384 {
5385 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5386 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5387 }
5388 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
5389 {
5390 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
5391 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5392 }
5393 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
5394 {
5395 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
5396 {
5397 unsigned int adjust;
5398
5399 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
5400 if (adjust != 0)
5401 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
5402 }
5403 }
5404 }
5405
5406 return TRUE;
5407 }
5408
5409 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
5410 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
5411 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
5412
5413 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
5414 how to. */
5415
5416 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,const char * name,int shindex)5417 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
5418 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
5419 const char *name,
5420 int shindex)
5421 {
5422 flagword flags = 0;
5423
5424 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
5425 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
5426 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
5427 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
5428 probably get away with this. */
5429 switch (hdr->sh_type)
5430 {
5431 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
5432 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
5433 return FALSE;
5434 break;
5435 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
5436 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
5437 return FALSE;
5438 break;
5439 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
5440 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
5441 return FALSE;
5442 break;
5443 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
5444 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5445 return FALSE;
5446 break;
5447 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
5448 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
5449 return FALSE;
5450 break;
5451 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
5452 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
5453 return FALSE;
5454 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
5455 break;
5456 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
5457 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
5458 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
5459 return FALSE;
5460 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
5461 break;
5462 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
5463 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
5464 return FALSE;
5465 break;
5466 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
5467 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5468 return FALSE;
5469 break;
5470 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
5471 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5472 return FALSE;
5473 break;
5474 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
5475 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5476 return FALSE;
5477 break;
5478 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
5479 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
5480 return FALSE;
5481 break;
5482 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
5483 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5484 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5485 return FALSE;
5486 break;
5487 default:
5488 break;
5489 }
5490
5491 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
5492 return FALSE;
5493
5494 if (flags)
5495 {
5496 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5497 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
5498 hdr->bfd_section)
5499 | flags)))
5500 return FALSE;
5501 }
5502
5503 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
5504
5505 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
5506 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
5507 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
5508 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
5509 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
5510 {
5511 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
5512 Elf32_RegInfo s;
5513
5514 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5515 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
5516 return FALSE;
5517 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
5518 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
5519 }
5520
5521 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
5522 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
5523 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
5524 they should agree. */
5525 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
5526 {
5527 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5528
5529 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
5530 if (contents == NULL)
5531 return FALSE;
5532 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
5533 0, hdr->sh_size))
5534 {
5535 free (contents);
5536 return FALSE;
5537 }
5538 l = contents;
5539 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5540 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5541 {
5542 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5543
5544 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5545 &intopt);
5546 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5547 {
5548 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5549 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5550 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5551 break;
5552 }
5553 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5554 {
5555 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
5556
5557 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
5558 (abfd,
5559 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
5560 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5561 &intreg);
5562 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5563 }
5564 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5565 {
5566 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
5567
5568 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
5569 (abfd,
5570 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
5571 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5572 &intreg);
5573 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5574 }
5575 l += intopt.size;
5576 }
5577 free (contents);
5578 }
5579
5580 return TRUE;
5581 }
5582
5583 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
5584 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
5585 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5586
5587 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,asection * sec)5588 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
5589 {
5590 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5591
5592 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
5593 {
5594 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
5595 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
5596 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5597 }
5598 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
5599 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
5600 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5601 {
5602 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
5603 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
5604 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5605 }
5606 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
5607 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
5608 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
5609 {
5610 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
5611 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
5612 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5613 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5614 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5615 else
5616 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5617 }
5618 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
5619 {
5620 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
5621 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
5622 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5623 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5624 {
5625 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5626 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5627 else
5628 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5629 }
5630 else
5631 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5632 }
5633 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5634 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
5635 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
5636 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
5637 {
5638 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5639 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5640 #if 0
5641 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
5642 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
5643 #endif
5644 }
5645 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
5646 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
5647 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5648 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
5649 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
5650 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
5651 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5652 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
5653 {
5654 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
5655 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5656 }
5657 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5658 {
5659 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
5660 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5661 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5662 }
5663 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5664 {
5665 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
5666 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5667 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5668 }
5669 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5670 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
5671 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
5672 {
5673 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
5674 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
5675 final_write_processing. */
5676 }
5677 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5678 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5679 {
5680 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
5681 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5682 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5683 }
5684 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
5685 {
5686 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
5687 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
5688 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
5689 }
5690
5691 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
5692 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
5693 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
5694 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
5695 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
5696
5697 return TRUE;
5698 }
5699
5700 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
5701 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
5702 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
5703 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
5704 the .scommon section. */
5705
5706 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,int * retval)5707 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5708 asection *sec, int *retval)
5709 {
5710 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
5711 {
5712 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5713 return TRUE;
5714 }
5715 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
5716 {
5717 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
5718 return TRUE;
5719 }
5720 return FALSE;
5721 }
5722
5723 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
5724 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
5725
5726 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep,flagword * flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)5727 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5728 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
5729 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5730 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
5731 {
5732 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5733 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
5734 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
5735 {
5736 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
5737 *namep = NULL;
5738 return TRUE;
5739 }
5740
5741 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
5742 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
5743 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
5744 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
5745 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
5746 is not done for them. */
5747 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
5748 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5749 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
5750 {
5751 *namep = NULL;
5752 return TRUE;
5753 }
5754
5755 switch (sym->st_shndx)
5756 {
5757 case SHN_COMMON:
5758 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5759 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
5760 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5761 || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
5762 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5763 break;
5764 /* Fall through. */
5765 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5766 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
5767 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
5768 *valp = sym->st_size;
5769 break;
5770
5771 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5772 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5773 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
5774 {
5775 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
5776 asection *elf_text_section;
5777 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5778
5779 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5780 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
5781 return FALSE;
5782
5783 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5784 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5785 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
5786 return FALSE;
5787
5788 /* Initialize the section. */
5789
5790 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
5791 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5792
5793 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5794 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
5795
5796 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
5797 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5798 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
5799 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
5800 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
5801 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5802 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
5803 }
5804 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5805 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5806 so I took it out. */
5807 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
5808 break;
5809
5810 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5811 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
5812 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5813 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5814 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
5815 {
5816 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
5817 asection *elf_data_section;
5818 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5819
5820 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5821 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
5822 return FALSE;
5823
5824 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5825 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5826 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
5827 return FALSE;
5828
5829 /* Initialize the section. */
5830
5831 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
5832 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5833
5834 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5835 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
5836
5837 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
5838 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5839 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
5840 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
5841 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
5842 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5843 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
5844 }
5845 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5846 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5847 so I took it out. */
5848 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
5849 break;
5850
5851 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5852 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5853 break;
5854 }
5855
5856 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5857 && ! info->shared
5858 && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
5859 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
5860 {
5861 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5862 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5863
5864 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
5865 bh = NULL;
5866 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5867 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
5868 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5869 return FALSE;
5870
5871 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5872 h->non_elf = 0;
5873 h->def_regular = 1;
5874 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5875
5876 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5877 return FALSE;
5878
5879 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
5880 }
5881
5882 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
5883 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
5884 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
5885 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5886 ++*valp;
5887
5888 return TRUE;
5889 }
5890
5891 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
5892 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
5893 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
5894
5895 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook(struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,asection * input_sec,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)5896 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
5897 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5898 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
5899 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5900 {
5901 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
5902 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
5903 common in the output file. */
5904 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
5905 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
5906 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5907
5908 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5909 sym->st_value &= ~1;
5910
5911 return TRUE;
5912 }
5913
5914 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
5915
5916 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
5917
5918 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)5919 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5920 {
5921 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5922 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5923 flagword flags;
5924 register asection *s;
5925 const char * const *namep;
5926 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5927
5928 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5929 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5930 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
5931
5932 /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
5933 EABI doesn't. */
5934 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
5935 {
5936 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5937 if (s != NULL)
5938 {
5939 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
5940 return FALSE;
5941 }
5942 }
5943
5944 /* We need to create .got section. */
5945 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
5946 return FALSE;
5947
5948 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
5949 return FALSE;
5950
5951 /* Create .stub section. */
5952 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5953 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
5954 {
5955 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
5956 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
5957 flags | SEC_CODE);
5958 if (s == NULL
5959 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5960 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5961 return FALSE;
5962 }
5963
5964 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
5965 && !info->shared
5966 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
5967 {
5968 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
5969 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
5970 if (s == NULL
5971 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5972 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5973 return FALSE;
5974 }
5975
5976 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
5977 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
5978 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
5979 the linker takes such action. */
5980 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
5981 {
5982 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
5983 {
5984 bh = NULL;
5985 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5986 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
5987 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5988 return FALSE;
5989
5990 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5991 h->non_elf = 0;
5992 h->def_regular = 1;
5993 h->type = STT_SECTION;
5994
5995 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5996 return FALSE;
5997 }
5998
5999 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
6000 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6001 {
6002 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
6003 return FALSE;
6004 }
6005
6006 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
6007 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
6008 if (s != NULL)
6009 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6010 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
6011 if (s != NULL)
6012 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6013 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
6014 if (s != NULL)
6015 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6016 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
6017 if (s != NULL)
6018 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6019 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6020 if (s != NULL)
6021 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6022 }
6023
6024 if (!info->shared)
6025 {
6026 const char *name;
6027
6028 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
6029 bh = NULL;
6030 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6031 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
6032 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6033 return FALSE;
6034
6035 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6036 h->non_elf = 0;
6037 h->def_regular = 1;
6038 h->type = STT_SECTION;
6039
6040 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6041 return FALSE;
6042
6043 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
6044 {
6045 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
6046 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
6047 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
6048 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
6049 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
6050 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6051
6052 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
6053 bh = NULL;
6054 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6055 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
6056 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6057 return FALSE;
6058
6059 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6060 h->non_elf = 0;
6061 h->def_regular = 1;
6062 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
6063
6064 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6065 return FALSE;
6066 }
6067 }
6068
6069 if (htab->is_vxworks)
6070 {
6071 /* Create the .plt, .rela.plt, .dynbss and .rela.bss sections.
6072 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE symbol. */
6073 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
6074 return FALSE;
6075
6076 /* Cache the sections created above. */
6077 htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynbss");
6078 htab->srelbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.bss");
6079 htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
6080 htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
6081 if (!htab->sdynbss
6082 || (!htab->srelbss && !info->shared)
6083 || !htab->srelplt
6084 || !htab->splt)
6085 abort ();
6086
6087 /* Do the usual VxWorks handling. */
6088 if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
6089 return FALSE;
6090
6091 /* Work out the PLT sizes. */
6092 if (info->shared)
6093 {
6094 htab->plt_header_size
6095 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
6096 htab->plt_entry_size
6097 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
6098 }
6099 else
6100 {
6101 htab->plt_header_size
6102 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
6103 htab->plt_entry_size
6104 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
6105 }
6106 }
6107
6108 return TRUE;
6109 }
6110
6111 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
6112 allocate space in the global offset table. */
6113
6114 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs)6115 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6116 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
6117 {
6118 const char *name;
6119 bfd *dynobj;
6120 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6121 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6122 struct mips_got_info *g;
6123 size_t extsymoff;
6124 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6125 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
6126 asection *sgot;
6127 asection *sreloc;
6128 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6129 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6130
6131 if (info->relocatable)
6132 return TRUE;
6133
6134 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6135 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6136 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6137 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
6138 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6139
6140 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
6141
6142 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
6143 if (FN_STUB_P (name))
6144 {
6145 unsigned long r_symndx;
6146
6147 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6148 this is for. */
6149
6150 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6151
6152 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6153 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6154 {
6155 asection *o;
6156
6157 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
6158 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
6159 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
6160 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6161 {
6162 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6163 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6164
6165 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
6166 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6167 || o->reloc_count == 0
6168 || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6169 continue;
6170
6171 sec_relocs
6172 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6173 info->keep_memory);
6174 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6175 return FALSE;
6176
6177 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6178 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6179 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6180 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
6181 break;
6182
6183 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6184 free (sec_relocs);
6185
6186 if (r < rend)
6187 break;
6188 }
6189
6190 if (o == NULL)
6191 {
6192 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6193 not need it. Since this function is called before
6194 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6195 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6196 flag. */
6197 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6198 return TRUE;
6199 }
6200
6201 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
6202 this BFD. */
6203 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
6204 {
6205 unsigned long symcount;
6206 asection **n;
6207 bfd_size_type amt;
6208
6209 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6210 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6211 else
6212 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6213 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6214 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6215 if (n == NULL)
6216 return FALSE;
6217 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
6218 }
6219
6220 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6221 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6222
6223 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6224 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6225 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
6226 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
6227 }
6228 else
6229 {
6230 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6231
6232 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6233 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6234
6235 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6236 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6237 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6238
6239 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
6240
6241 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6242 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
6243 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6244 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6245 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
6246 if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
6247 {
6248 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6249 return TRUE;
6250 }
6251
6252 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6253 h->fn_stub = sec;
6254 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6255 }
6256 }
6257 else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6258 {
6259 unsigned long r_symndx;
6260 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6261 asection **loc;
6262
6263 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6264 this is for. */
6265
6266 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6267
6268 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6269 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6270 {
6271 asection *o;
6272
6273 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
6274 needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
6275 that refers to this symbol. */
6276 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6277 {
6278 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6279 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6280
6281 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
6282 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6283 || o->reloc_count == 0
6284 || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6285 continue;
6286
6287 sec_relocs
6288 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6289 info->keep_memory);
6290 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6291 return FALSE;
6292
6293 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6294 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6295 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6296 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
6297 break;
6298
6299 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6300 free (sec_relocs);
6301
6302 if (r < rend)
6303 break;
6304 }
6305
6306 if (o == NULL)
6307 {
6308 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6309 not need it. Since this function is called before
6310 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6311 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6312 flag. */
6313 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6314 return TRUE;
6315 }
6316
6317 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
6318 this BFD. */
6319 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
6320 {
6321 unsigned long symcount;
6322 asection **n;
6323 bfd_size_type amt;
6324
6325 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6326 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6327 else
6328 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6329 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6330 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6331 if (n == NULL)
6332 return FALSE;
6333 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
6334 }
6335
6336 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6337 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6338
6339 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6340 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6341 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
6342 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
6343 }
6344 else
6345 {
6346 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6347 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6348
6349 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
6350
6351 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6352 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
6353 else
6354 loc = &h->call_stub;
6355
6356 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6357 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
6358 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6359 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6360 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
6361 if (*loc != NULL)
6362 {
6363 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6364 return TRUE;
6365 }
6366
6367 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6368 *loc = sec;
6369 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6370 }
6371 }
6372
6373 if (dynobj == NULL)
6374 {
6375 sgot = NULL;
6376 g = NULL;
6377 }
6378 else
6379 {
6380 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6381 if (sgot == NULL)
6382 g = NULL;
6383 else
6384 {
6385 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
6386 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
6387 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6388 }
6389 }
6390
6391 sreloc = NULL;
6392 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6393 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6394 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
6395 {
6396 unsigned long r_symndx;
6397 unsigned int r_type;
6398 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6399
6400 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
6401 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
6402
6403 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
6404 h = NULL;
6405 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
6406 {
6407 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6408 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
6409 abfd, name);
6410 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6411 return FALSE;
6412 }
6413 else
6414 {
6415 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
6416
6417 /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */
6418 if (h != NULL)
6419 {
6420 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6421 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
6422 }
6423 }
6424
6425 /* Some relocs require a global offset table. */
6426 if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
6427 {
6428 switch (r_type)
6429 {
6430 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6431 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6432 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6433 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6434 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6435 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6436 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6437 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6438 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6439 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6440 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6441 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6442 if (dynobj == NULL)
6443 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6444 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
6445 return FALSE;
6446 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6447 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
6448 {
6449 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6450 (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
6451 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6452 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6453 return FALSE;
6454 }
6455 break;
6456
6457 case R_MIPS_32:
6458 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6459 case R_MIPS_64:
6460 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6461 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6462 no need to add a dynamic relocation here. */
6463 if (dynobj == NULL
6464 && (info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6465 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6466 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6467 break;
6468
6469 default:
6470 break;
6471 }
6472 }
6473
6474 if (h)
6475 {
6476 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_relocation_target = TRUE;
6477
6478 /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
6479 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader. Allocate
6480 room for them in .rela.dyn. */
6481 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
6482 {
6483 if (sreloc == NULL)
6484 {
6485 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6486 if (sreloc == NULL)
6487 return FALSE;
6488 }
6489 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6490 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6491 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6492 relocations against the text segment. */
6493 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6494 }
6495 }
6496 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
6497 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
6498 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP
6499 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 && htab->is_vxworks))
6500 {
6501 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
6502 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
6503 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
6504 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
6505 R_MIPS_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
6506 always evaluate to "G". We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
6507 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
6508 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
6509 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6510 rel->r_addend, g, 0))
6511 return FALSE;
6512 }
6513
6514 switch (r_type)
6515 {
6516 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6517 if (h == NULL)
6518 {
6519 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6520 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
6521 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6522 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6523 return FALSE;
6524 }
6525 /* Fall through. */
6526
6527 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6528 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6529 if (h != NULL)
6530 {
6531 /* VxWorks call relocations point the function's .got.plt
6532 entry, which will be allocated by adjust_dynamic_symbol.
6533 Otherwise, this symbol requires a global GOT entry. */
6534 if (!htab->is_vxworks
6535 && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6536 return FALSE;
6537
6538 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
6539 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
6540 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
6541 h->needs_plt = 1;
6542 h->type = STT_FUNC;
6543 }
6544 break;
6545
6546 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6547 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
6548 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
6549 if (h == NULL)
6550 break;
6551 else
6552 {
6553 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6554 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6555
6556 while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6557 || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6558 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6559 hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
6560
6561 if (hmips->root.def_regular
6562 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
6563 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
6564 break;
6565 }
6566 /* Fall through. */
6567
6568 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6569 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6570 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6571 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6572 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6573 return FALSE;
6574 break;
6575
6576 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6577 if (info->shared)
6578 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
6579 /* Fall through */
6580
6581 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6582 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
6583 {
6584 r_symndx = 0;
6585 h = NULL;
6586 }
6587 /* Fall through */
6588
6589 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6590 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
6591 for TLS GD relocations. */
6592 {
6593 unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
6594 ? GOT_TLS_GD
6595 : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
6596 ? GOT_TLS_LDM
6597 : GOT_TLS_IE);
6598 if (h != NULL)
6599 {
6600 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6601 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6602 hmips->tls_type |= flag;
6603
6604 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, flag))
6605 return FALSE;
6606 }
6607 else
6608 {
6609 BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != 0);
6610
6611 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6612 rel->r_addend, g, flag))
6613 return FALSE;
6614 }
6615 }
6616 break;
6617
6618 case R_MIPS_32:
6619 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6620 case R_MIPS_64:
6621 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6622 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6623 no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation. */
6624 if ((info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6625 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6626 {
6627 if (sreloc == NULL)
6628 {
6629 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6630 if (sreloc == NULL)
6631 return FALSE;
6632 }
6633 if (info->shared)
6634 {
6635 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
6636 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
6637 relocs. Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn. */
6638 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6639 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6640 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6641 relocations against the text segment. */
6642 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6643 }
6644 else
6645 {
6646 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6647
6648 /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
6649 defined in a dynamic object. */
6650 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6651 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
6652 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6653 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
6654 are relocations against the text segment. */
6655 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
6656 }
6657
6658 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
6659 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
6660 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
6661 dynamic relocations against it. This does not apply
6662 to VxWorks, which does not have the usual coupling
6663 between global GOT entries and .dynsym entries. */
6664 if (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
6665 {
6666 if (dynobj == NULL)
6667 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6668 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
6669 return FALSE;
6670 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6671 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6672 return FALSE;
6673 }
6674 }
6675
6676 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6677 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6678 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6679 break;
6680
6681 case R_MIPS_PC16:
6682 if (h)
6683 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6684 break;
6685
6686 case R_MIPS_26:
6687 if (h)
6688 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6689 /* Fall through. */
6690
6691 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
6692 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
6693 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6694 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6695 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6696 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6697 break;
6698
6699 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
6700 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
6701 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6702 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6703 return FALSE;
6704 break;
6705
6706 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
6707 used. Record for later use during GC. */
6708 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6709 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6710 return FALSE;
6711 break;
6712
6713 default:
6714 break;
6715 }
6716
6717 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
6718 related to taking the function's address. This doesn't apply to
6719 VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer to a .got.plt entry instead of
6720 a normal .got entry. */
6721 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h != NULL)
6722 switch (r_type)
6723 {
6724 default:
6725 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
6726 break;
6727 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6728 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6729 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6730 case R_MIPS_JALR:
6731 break;
6732 }
6733
6734 /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
6735 symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
6736 References from a stub section do not count. */
6737 if (h != NULL
6738 && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
6739 && !mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, sec))
6740 {
6741 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6742
6743 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6744 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
6745 }
6746 }
6747
6748 return TRUE;
6749 }
6750
6751 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_relax_section(bfd * abfd,asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,bfd_boolean * again)6752 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
6753 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6754 bfd_boolean *again)
6755 {
6756 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6757 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
6758 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6759 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6760 size_t extsymoff;
6761 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
6762 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
6763 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6764
6765 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
6766 *again = FALSE;
6767
6768 if (link_info->relocatable)
6769 return TRUE;
6770
6771 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
6772 link_info->keep_memory);
6773 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6774 return TRUE;
6775
6776 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
6777 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6778 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6779 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6780
6781 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6782 {
6783 bfd_vma symval;
6784 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
6785 unsigned int r_type;
6786 unsigned long r_symndx;
6787 asection *sym_sec;
6788 unsigned long instruction;
6789
6790 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
6791 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
6792 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
6793 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
6794 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
6795 continue;
6796
6797 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
6798 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
6799 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
6800 {
6801 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
6802 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6803 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6804
6805 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6806 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6807 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6808
6809 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
6810 skip it. */
6811 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6812 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6813 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
6814 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
6815 && !h->root.forced_local))
6816 continue;
6817
6818 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
6819 if (sym_sec->output_section)
6820 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
6821 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6822 + sym_sec->output_offset);
6823 else
6824 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
6825 }
6826 else
6827 {
6828 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6829
6830 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
6831 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
6832 {
6833 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6834 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6835 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
6836 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
6837 NULL, NULL, NULL);
6838 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6839 goto relax_return;
6840 }
6841
6842 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
6843 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
6844 continue;
6845 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6846 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6847 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
6848 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
6849 else
6850 sym_sec
6851 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
6852 symval = isym->st_value
6853 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6854 + sym_sec->output_offset;
6855 }
6856
6857 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
6858 branch target. */
6859 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
6860 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
6861
6862 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
6863 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
6864 continue;
6865
6866 sym_offset >>= 2;
6867
6868 /* Check that it's in range. */
6869 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
6870 continue;
6871
6872 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
6873 if (contents == NULL)
6874 {
6875 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6876 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6877 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6878 else
6879 {
6880 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6881 goto relax_return;
6882 }
6883 }
6884
6885 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
6886
6887 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
6888 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
6889 instruction = 0x04110000;
6890 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
6891 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
6892 instruction = 0x10000000;
6893 else
6894 continue;
6895
6896 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
6897 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
6898 changed_contents = TRUE;
6899 }
6900
6901 if (contents != NULL
6902 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6903 {
6904 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
6905 free (contents);
6906 else
6907 {
6908 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6909 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6910 }
6911 }
6912 return TRUE;
6913
6914 relax_return:
6915 if (contents != NULL
6916 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6917 free (contents);
6918 return FALSE;
6919 }
6920
6921 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6922 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6923 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6924 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6925 understand. */
6926
6927 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6928 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6929 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6930 {
6931 bfd *dynobj;
6932 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6933 asection *s;
6934 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6935
6936 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6937 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6938
6939 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
6940 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
6941 && (h->needs_plt
6942 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
6943 || (h->def_dynamic
6944 && h->ref_regular
6945 && !h->def_regular)));
6946
6947 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
6948 any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
6949 file. */
6950 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6951 if (! info->relocatable
6952 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
6953 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6954 || !h->def_regular))
6955 {
6956 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
6957 (dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
6958 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
6959 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
6960 against the text segment. */
6961 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6962 }
6963
6964 /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */
6965 if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
6966 && h->needs_plt)
6967 {
6968 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6969 return TRUE;
6970
6971 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
6972 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
6973 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
6974 executable and the shared library. */
6975 if (!h->def_regular)
6976 {
6977 /* We need .stub section. */
6978 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
6979 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
6980 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6981
6982 h->root.u.def.section = s;
6983 h->root.u.def.value = s->size;
6984
6985 /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */
6986 h->plt.offset = s->size;
6987
6988 /* Make room for this stub code. */
6989 s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
6990
6991 /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
6992 of this symbol in .dynsym section. */
6993 return TRUE;
6994 }
6995 }
6996 else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
6997 && !h->needs_plt)
6998 {
6999 /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
7000 the dynamic linker will take care of this. */
7001 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7002 return TRUE;
7003 }
7004
7005 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7006 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7007 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
7008 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7009 {
7010 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7011 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7012 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7013 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7014 return TRUE;
7015 }
7016
7017 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7018 is not a function. */
7019
7020 return TRUE;
7021 }
7022
7023 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
7024
7025 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)7026 _bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
7027 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
7028 {
7029 bfd *dynobj;
7030 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7031 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7032
7033 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7034 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7035 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7036
7037 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
7038 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
7039 && (h->needs_plt
7040 || h->needs_copy
7041 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
7042 || (h->def_dynamic
7043 && h->ref_regular
7044 && !h->def_regular)));
7045
7046 /* If the symbol is defined by a dynamic object, we need a PLT stub if
7047 either (a) we want to branch to the symbol or (b) we're linking an
7048 executable that needs a canonical function address. In the latter
7049 case, the canonical address will be the address of the executable's
7050 load stub. */
7051 if ((hmips->is_branch_target
7052 || (!info->shared
7053 && h->type == STT_FUNC
7054 && hmips->is_relocation_target))
7055 && h->def_dynamic
7056 && h->ref_regular
7057 && !h->def_regular
7058 && !h->forced_local)
7059 h->needs_plt = 1;
7060
7061 /* Locally-binding symbols do not need a PLT stub; we can refer to
7062 the functions directly. */
7063 else if (h->needs_plt
7064 && (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
7065 || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
7066 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)))
7067 {
7068 h->needs_plt = 0;
7069 return TRUE;
7070 }
7071
7072 if (h->needs_plt)
7073 {
7074 /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, allocate room
7075 for the header, and for the header's .rela.plt.unloaded entries. */
7076 if (htab->splt->size == 0)
7077 {
7078 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
7079 if (!info->shared)
7080 htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7081 }
7082
7083 /* Assign the next .plt entry to this symbol. */
7084 h->plt.offset = htab->splt->size;
7085 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
7086
7087 /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
7088 symbol's value to the address of the stub. For executables,
7089 point at the PLT load stub rather than the lazy resolution stub;
7090 this stub will become the canonical function address. */
7091 if (!h->def_regular)
7092 {
7093 h->root.u.def.section = htab->splt;
7094 h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
7095 if (!info->shared)
7096 h->root.u.def.value += 8;
7097 }
7098
7099 /* Make room for the .got.plt entry and the R_JUMP_SLOT relocation. */
7100 htab->sgotplt->size += 4;
7101 htab->srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7102
7103 /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations. */
7104 if (!info->shared)
7105 htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7106
7107 return TRUE;
7108 }
7109
7110 /* If a function symbol is defined by a dynamic object, and we do not
7111 need a PLT stub for it, the symbol's value should be zero. */
7112 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
7113 && h->def_dynamic
7114 && h->ref_regular
7115 && !h->def_regular)
7116 {
7117 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7118 return TRUE;
7119 }
7120
7121 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7122 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7123 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
7124 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7125 {
7126 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7127 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7128 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7129 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7130 return TRUE;
7131 }
7132
7133 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7134 is not a function. */
7135 if (info->shared)
7136 return TRUE;
7137
7138 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
7139 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
7140 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
7141 object will contain position independent code, so all references
7142 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
7143 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
7144 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
7145 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
7146 same memory location for the variable. */
7147
7148 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7149 {
7150 htab->srelbss->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7151 h->needs_copy = 1;
7152 }
7153
7154 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, htab->sdynbss);
7155 }
7156
7157 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
7158 The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
7159 much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
7160 the current linking stage. */
7161
7162 static bfd_size_type
count_section_dynsyms(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7163 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7164 {
7165 bfd_size_type count;
7166
7167 count = 0;
7168 if (info->shared || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
7169 {
7170 asection *p;
7171 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7172
7173 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7174 for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
7175 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
7176 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
7177 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
7178 ++count;
7179 }
7180 return count;
7181 }
7182
7183 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
7184 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
7185 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
7186
7187 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7188 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7189 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7190 {
7191 asection *ri;
7192
7193 bfd *dynobj;
7194 asection *s;
7195 struct mips_got_info *g;
7196 int i;
7197 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
7198 bfd_size_type local_gotno;
7199 bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
7200 bfd *sub;
7201 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
7202 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7203
7204 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7205
7206 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
7207 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
7208 if (ri != NULL)
7209 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
7210
7211 if (! (info->relocatable
7212 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
7213 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
7214 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
7215
7216 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7217 if (dynobj == NULL)
7218 /* Relocatable links don't have it. */
7219 return TRUE;
7220
7221 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
7222 if (s == NULL)
7223 return TRUE;
7224
7225 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
7226 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
7227 required. */
7228 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
7229 {
7230 asection *subsection;
7231
7232 for (subsection = sub->sections;
7233 subsection;
7234 subsection = subsection->next)
7235 {
7236 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
7237 continue;
7238 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
7239 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
7240 }
7241 }
7242
7243 /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
7244 a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
7245 higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
7246 that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We
7247 do that here. */
7248 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
7249 return FALSE;
7250
7251 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
7252 i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
7253 else
7254 /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
7255 relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */
7256 i = 0;
7257
7258 /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
7259 At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
7260 and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
7261 be needed. */
7262 dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
7263 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
7264
7265 /* Determine the size of one stub entry. */
7266 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
7267 ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
7268 : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
7269
7270 /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
7271 one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
7272 rld. */
7273 loadable_size += htab->function_stub_size * (i + 1);
7274
7275 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7276 /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS_GOT16
7277 relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
7278 not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE. */
7279 local_gotno = 0;
7280 else
7281 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
7282 sections. Is 5 enough? */
7283 local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
7284
7285 g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
7286 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7287
7288 g->global_gotno = i;
7289 s->size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7290
7291 /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
7292 instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
7293 entries for one global symbol from multiple input files. */
7294 count_tls_arg.info = info;
7295 count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
7296 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7297 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
7298 &count_tls_arg);
7299 g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
7300 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7301
7302 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7303
7304 /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs. It initializes $gp to
7305 __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
7306 dynamic loader. */
7307 if (!htab->is_vxworks && s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
7308 {
7309 if (! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
7310 return FALSE;
7311 }
7312 else
7313 {
7314 /* Set up TLS entries for the first GOT. */
7315 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
7316 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
7317 }
7318
7319 return TRUE;
7320 }
7321
7322 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
7323
7324 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7325 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7326 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7327 {
7328 bfd *dynobj;
7329 asection *s, *sreldyn;
7330 bfd_boolean reltext;
7331 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7332
7333 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7334 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7335 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
7336
7337 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7338 {
7339 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
7340 if (info->executable)
7341 {
7342 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
7343 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7344 s->size
7345 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
7346 s->contents
7347 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
7348 }
7349 }
7350
7351 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
7352 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
7353 memory for them. */
7354 reltext = FALSE;
7355 sreldyn = NULL;
7356 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7357 {
7358 const char *name;
7359
7360 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
7361 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
7362 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
7363
7364 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
7365 continue;
7366
7367 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
7368 {
7369 if (s->size != 0)
7370 {
7371 const char *outname;
7372 asection *target;
7373
7374 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
7375 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
7376 If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
7377 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
7378 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
7379 not. */
7380 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
7381 s->output_section);
7382 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
7383 if ((target != NULL
7384 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
7385 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7386 || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7387 reltext = TRUE;
7388
7389 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
7390 to copy relocs into the output file. */
7391 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
7392 s->reloc_count = 0;
7393
7394 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
7395 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
7396 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
7397 will move them around between input sections'
7398 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
7399 broken, so don't let it run. */
7400 info->combreloc = 0;
7401 }
7402 }
7403 else if (htab->is_vxworks && strcmp (name, ".got") == 0)
7404 {
7405 /* Executables do not need a GOT. */
7406 if (info->shared)
7407 {
7408 /* Allocate relocations for all but the reserved entries. */
7409 struct mips_got_info *g;
7410 unsigned int count;
7411
7412 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7413 count = (g->global_gotno
7414 + g->local_gotno
7415 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7416 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, count);
7417 }
7418 }
7419 else if (!htab->is_vxworks && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".got"))
7420 {
7421 /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
7422 most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
7423 to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
7424 hash tables. */
7425 struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7426 struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
7427 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
7428 unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
7429
7430 if (gg->next)
7431 {
7432 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7433 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
7434
7435 /* NOTE 2005-02-03: How can this call, or the next, ever
7436 find any indirect entries to resolve? They were all
7437 resolved in mips_elf_multi_got. */
7438 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
7439 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7440 {
7441 unsigned int save_assign;
7442
7443 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7444
7445 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
7446 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
7447 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
7448 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
7449 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
7450 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
7451 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
7452 &set_got_offset_arg);
7453 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
7454 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
7455 <= g->global_gotno);
7456
7457 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
7458 if (info->shared)
7459 {
7460 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
7461 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
7462 + g->next->global_gotno
7463 + g->next->tls_gotno
7464 + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7465 }
7466 }
7467 }
7468 else
7469 {
7470 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
7471 arg.info = info;
7472 arg.needed = 0;
7473
7474 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs,
7475 &arg);
7476 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7477 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
7478 &arg);
7479
7480 needed_relocs += arg.needed;
7481 }
7482
7483 if (needed_relocs)
7484 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
7485 needed_relocs);
7486 }
7487 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
7488 {
7489 /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
7490 of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */
7491 s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
7492 }
7493 else if (! info->shared
7494 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7495 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
7496 {
7497 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
7498 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
7499 s->size += MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE (output_bfd);
7500 }
7501 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7502 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
7503 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
7504 else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
7505 && s != htab->sgotplt
7506 && s != htab->splt)
7507 {
7508 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
7509 continue;
7510 }
7511
7512 if (s->size == 0)
7513 {
7514 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7515 continue;
7516 }
7517
7518 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
7519 continue;
7520
7521 /* Allocate memory for this section last, since we may increase its
7522 size above. */
7523 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7524 {
7525 sreldyn = s;
7526 continue;
7527 }
7528
7529 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
7530 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
7531 if (s->contents == NULL)
7532 {
7533 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7534 return FALSE;
7535 }
7536 }
7537
7538 /* Allocate memory for the .rel(a).dyn section. */
7539 if (sreldyn != NULL)
7540 {
7541 sreldyn->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, sreldyn->size);
7542 if (sreldyn->contents == NULL)
7543 {
7544 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7545 return FALSE;
7546 }
7547 }
7548
7549 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7550 {
7551 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
7552 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
7553 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
7554 the .dynamic section. */
7555
7556 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
7557 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. This must come first because glibc
7558 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and GDB only
7559 looks at the first one it sees. */
7560 if (!info->shared
7561 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
7562 return FALSE;
7563
7564 /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
7565 used by the debugger. */
7566 if (info->executable
7567 && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7568 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
7569 return FALSE;
7570
7571 if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
7572 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7573
7574 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
7575 {
7576 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
7577 return FALSE;
7578
7579 /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag. It will be set again if we
7580 write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
7581 at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
7582 absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative. */
7583 info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
7584 }
7585
7586 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
7587 return FALSE;
7588
7589 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7590 {
7591 /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn. It does not
7592 use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags. */
7593 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7594 {
7595 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
7596 return FALSE;
7597
7598 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
7599 return FALSE;
7600
7601 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
7602 return FALSE;
7603 }
7604 if (htab->splt->size > 0)
7605 {
7606 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
7607 return FALSE;
7608
7609 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
7610 return FALSE;
7611
7612 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
7613 return FALSE;
7614 }
7615 }
7616 else
7617 {
7618 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7619 {
7620 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
7621 return FALSE;
7622
7623 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
7624 return FALSE;
7625
7626 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
7627 return FALSE;
7628 }
7629
7630 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
7631 return FALSE;
7632
7633 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
7634 return FALSE;
7635
7636 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
7637 return FALSE;
7638
7639 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
7640 return FALSE;
7641
7642 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
7643 return FALSE;
7644
7645 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
7646 return FALSE;
7647
7648 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
7649 return FALSE;
7650
7651 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
7652 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
7653 return FALSE;
7654
7655 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
7656 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
7657 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
7658 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
7659 return FALSE;
7660 }
7661 }
7662
7663 return TRUE;
7664 }
7665
7666 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
7667 Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
7668 LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
7669 and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes. */
7670
7671 static void
mips_elf_adjust_addend(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)7672 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7673 bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7674 asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
7675 {
7676 unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
7677 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7678 asection *sec;
7679
7680 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7681 {
7682 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7683 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
7684 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
7685 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
7686 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
7687 {
7688 rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
7689 rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
7690 }
7691
7692 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7693 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7694
7695 /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging. */
7696 if (!info->relocatable)
7697 {
7698 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7699 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7700 }
7701
7702 /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c. */
7703 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
7704 rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
7705 }
7706 }
7707
7708 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
7709
7710 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections)7711 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7712 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
7713 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7714 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7715 asection **local_sections)
7716 {
7717 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7718 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7719 bfd_vma addend = 0;
7720 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
7721 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7722
7723 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7724 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7725 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
7726 {
7727 const char *name;
7728 bfd_vma value = 0;
7729 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7730 bfd_boolean require_jalx;
7731 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
7732 REL relocation. */
7733 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
7734 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7735 const char *msg;
7736 unsigned long r_symndx;
7737 asection *sec;
7738 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7739 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7740
7741 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
7742 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
7743 NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
7744 && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
7745 (input_bfd, input_section,
7746 rel - relocs)));
7747
7748 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
7749 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
7750 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7751 {
7752 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7753 h = NULL;
7754 }
7755 else
7756 {
7757 unsigned long extsymoff;
7758
7759 extsymoff = 0;
7760 if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
7761 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7762 h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
7763 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7764 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
7765 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
7766
7767 sec = NULL;
7768 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7769 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7770 sec = h->root.u.def.section;
7771 }
7772
7773 if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
7774 {
7775 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7776 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7777 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7778 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7779 rel->r_info = 0;
7780 rel->r_addend = 0;
7781 continue;
7782 }
7783
7784 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
7785 {
7786 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
7787 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
7788 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
7789 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
7790 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
7791 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
7792 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
7793
7794 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
7795 of the reloc. */
7796 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7797 rel->r_offset += 4;
7798 }
7799
7800 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
7801 {
7802 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7803
7804 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
7805 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
7806 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
7807 RELA relocation. To determine which flavor or relocation
7808 this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
7809 REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */
7810 rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
7811 if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7812 >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
7813 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
7814 if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
7815 {
7816 bfd_byte *location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7817
7818 /* Note that this is a REL relocation. */
7819 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
7820
7821 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
7822 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7823 location);
7824 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
7825 contents);
7826 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7827 location);
7828
7829 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7830
7831 /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
7832 combination of the addend stored in two different
7833 relocations. */
7834 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
7835 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
7836 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
7837 local_sections, FALSE)))
7838 {
7839 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7840 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7841 int lo16_type;
7842
7843 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
7844 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7845 else
7846 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7847
7848 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
7849 left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
7850 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the code does
7851 a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
7852 the LO16 value.)
7853
7854 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7855
7856 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16
7857 relocation must be immediately following.
7858 However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next relocation
7859 may be a composed relocation consisting of
7860 several relocations for the same address. In
7861 that case, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation may occur
7862 as one of these. We permit a similar extension
7863 in general, as that is useful for GCC.
7864
7865 In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes
7866 the LO16 but keeps the corresponding HI16. This
7867 is strictly speaking a violation of the ABI but
7868 not immediately harmful. */
7869 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd,
7870 lo16_type,
7871 rel, relend);
7872 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7873 {
7874 const char *name;
7875
7876 if (h)
7877 name = h->root.root.string;
7878 else
7879 name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
7880 local_syms + r_symndx,
7881 sec);
7882 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7883 (_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
7884 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
7885 rel->r_offset);
7886 }
7887 else
7888 {
7889 bfd_byte *lo16_location;
7890 bfd_vma l;
7891
7892 lo16_location = contents + lo16_relocation->r_offset;
7893
7894 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
7895 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd,
7896 lo16_type, FALSE);
7897 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7898 FALSE, lo16_location);
7899 l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto,
7900 lo16_relocation,
7901 input_bfd, contents);
7902 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7903 FALSE, lo16_location);
7904 l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
7905 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7906 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7907
7908 addend <<= 16;
7909
7910 /* Compute the combined addend. */
7911 addend += l;
7912 }
7913 }
7914 else
7915 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
7916 }
7917 else
7918 addend = rel->r_addend;
7919 mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
7920 local_syms, local_sections, rel);
7921 }
7922
7923 if (info->relocatable)
7924 {
7925 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
7926 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7927 rel->r_offset -= 4;
7928
7929 if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
7930 {
7931 addend += rel->r_addend;
7932 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
7933 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
7934 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
7935 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
7936 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
7937 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
7938 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
7939 else
7940 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
7941
7942 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
7943 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
7944 source of the addend in the final link. */
7945 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7946
7947 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7948 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7949 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
7950 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
7951 but for endianness. */
7952 {
7953 bfd_vma sign_bits;
7954 bfd_vma low_bits;
7955 bfd_vma high_bits;
7956
7957 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7958 #ifdef BFD64
7959 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7960 #else
7961 sign_bits = -1;
7962 #endif
7963 else
7964 sign_bits = 0;
7965
7966 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7967 do two separate stores. */
7968 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7969 {
7970 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7971 first. */
7972 low_bits = sign_bits;
7973 high_bits = addend;
7974 }
7975 else
7976 {
7977 low_bits = addend;
7978 high_bits = sign_bits;
7979 }
7980 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7981 contents + rel->r_offset);
7982 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7983 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7984 continue;
7985 }
7986
7987 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
7988 input_bfd, input_section,
7989 contents, FALSE))
7990 return FALSE;
7991 }
7992
7993 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
7994 continue;
7995 }
7996
7997 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
7998 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
7999 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
8000 for the next. */
8001 if (rel + 1 < relend
8002 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
8003 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
8004 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
8005 else
8006 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
8007
8008 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
8009 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
8010 input_section, info, rel,
8011 addend, howto, local_syms,
8012 local_sections, &value,
8013 &name, &require_jalx,
8014 use_saved_addend_p))
8015 {
8016 case bfd_reloc_continue:
8017 /* There's nothing to do. */
8018 continue;
8019
8020 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8021 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
8022 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
8023 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
8024 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
8025 continue;
8026
8027 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
8028 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
8029 info->callbacks->warning
8030 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
8031 return FALSE;
8032
8033 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8034 if (use_saved_addend_p)
8035 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
8036 a given location. */
8037 ;
8038 else
8039 {
8040 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
8041 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8042 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
8043 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
8044 return FALSE;
8045 }
8046 break;
8047
8048 case bfd_reloc_ok:
8049 break;
8050
8051 default:
8052 abort ();
8053 break;
8054 }
8055
8056 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
8057 until we reach the last one. */
8058 if (use_saved_addend_p)
8059 {
8060 addend = value;
8061 continue;
8062 }
8063
8064 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8065 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
8066 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
8067 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
8068 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
8069 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
8070 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
8071 only a 32-bit VMA. */
8072 {
8073 bfd_vma sign_bits;
8074 bfd_vma low_bits;
8075 bfd_vma high_bits;
8076
8077 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
8078 #ifdef BFD64
8079 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
8080 #else
8081 sign_bits = -1;
8082 #endif
8083 else
8084 sign_bits = 0;
8085
8086 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
8087 do two separate stores. */
8088 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8089 {
8090 /* Undo what we did above. */
8091 rel->r_offset -= 4;
8092 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
8093 first. */
8094 low_bits = sign_bits;
8095 high_bits = value;
8096 }
8097 else
8098 {
8099 low_bits = value;
8100 high_bits = sign_bits;
8101 }
8102 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
8103 contents + rel->r_offset);
8104 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
8105 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
8106 continue;
8107 }
8108
8109 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
8110 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
8111 input_bfd, input_section,
8112 contents, require_jalx))
8113 return FALSE;
8114 }
8115
8116 return TRUE;
8117 }
8118
8119 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
8120 adjust it appropriately now. */
8121
8122 static void
mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8123 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8124 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8125 {
8126 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
8127 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
8128 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
8129 "_ftext",
8130 "_etext",
8131 "__dso_displacement",
8132 "__elf_header",
8133 "__program_header_table",
8134 NULL
8135 };
8136
8137 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
8138 "_fdata",
8139 "_edata",
8140 "_end",
8141 "_fbss",
8142 NULL
8143 };
8144
8145 const char* const *p;
8146 int i;
8147
8148 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
8149 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
8150 *p;
8151 ++p)
8152 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
8153 {
8154 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
8155 IRIX6 linker. */
8156 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8157 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8158
8159 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
8160 if (i == 0)
8161 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8162 else
8163 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8164
8165 break;
8166 }
8167 }
8168
8169 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
8170 dynamic sections here. */
8171
8172 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8173 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8174 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8175 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8176 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8177 {
8178 bfd *dynobj;
8179 asection *sgot;
8180 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
8181 const char *name;
8182 int idx;
8183 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8184
8185 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8186 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8187
8188 if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
8189 {
8190 asection *s;
8191 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
8192
8193 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
8194
8195 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8196
8197 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
8198 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
8199 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8200
8201 BFD_ASSERT ((htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8202 || (h->dynindx <= 0xffff));
8203
8204 /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed. Larger values would cause
8205 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
8206 index value. */
8207 if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
8208 return FALSE;
8209
8210 /* Fill the stub. */
8211 idx = 0;
8212 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8213 idx += 4;
8214 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8215 idx += 4;
8216 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8217 {
8218 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
8219 stub + idx);
8220 idx += 4;
8221 }
8222 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
8223 idx += 4;
8224
8225 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
8226 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
8227 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8228 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8229 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
8230 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8231 else
8232 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
8233 stub + idx);
8234
8235 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->size);
8236 memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, htab->function_stub_size);
8237
8238 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
8239 only for the referenced symbol. */
8240 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8241
8242 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
8243 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
8244 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
8245 sym->st_value = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
8246 + h->plt.offset);
8247 }
8248
8249 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
8250 || h->forced_local);
8251
8252 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8253 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8254 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8255 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8256 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8257
8258 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
8259 the symbols that need them. */
8260 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8261 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8262 {
8263 bfd_vma offset;
8264 bfd_vma value;
8265
8266 value = sym->st_value;
8267 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h, R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8268 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
8269 }
8270
8271 if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1 && h->type != STT_TLS)
8272 {
8273 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
8274 bfd_vma entry;
8275 bfd_vma offset;
8276
8277 gg = g;
8278
8279 e.abfd = output_bfd;
8280 e.symndx = -1;
8281 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
8282 e.tls_type = 0;
8283
8284 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8285 {
8286 if (g->got_entries
8287 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
8288 &e)))
8289 {
8290 offset = p->gotidx;
8291 if (info->shared
8292 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
8293 && p->d.h != NULL
8294 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
8295 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
8296 {
8297 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
8298 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
8299 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
8300 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
8301 appropriate addend. */
8302 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8303
8304 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8305 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
8306 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
8307 else
8308 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
8309 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
8310
8311 entry = 0;
8312 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8313 (output_bfd, info, rel,
8314 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
8315 return FALSE;
8316 }
8317 else
8318 entry = sym->st_value;
8319 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
8320 }
8321 }
8322 }
8323
8324 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
8325 name = h->root.root.string;
8326 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
8327 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
8328 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8329 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
8330 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
8331 {
8332 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8333 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8334 sym->st_value = 1;
8335 }
8336 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8337 {
8338 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8339 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8340 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
8341 }
8342 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
8343 {
8344 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
8345 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
8346 {
8347 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8348 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8349 sym->st_value = 0;
8350 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8351 }
8352 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
8353 {
8354 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8355 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8356 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
8357 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8358 }
8359 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
8360 {
8361 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
8362 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8363 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
8364 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8365 }
8366 }
8367
8368 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
8369 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
8370 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
8371
8372 if (! info->shared)
8373 {
8374 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8375 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
8376 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
8377 {
8378 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
8379 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8380 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8381 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
8382 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
8383 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8384 }
8385 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8386 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
8387 {
8388 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
8389 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
8390 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
8391 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
8392 != NULL);
8393 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8394 }
8395 }
8396
8397 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
8398 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8399 sym->st_value &= ~1;
8400
8401 return TRUE;
8402 }
8403
8404 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
8405
8406 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8407 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8408 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8409 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8410 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8411 {
8412 bfd *dynobj;
8413 asection *sgot;
8414 struct mips_got_info *g;
8415 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8416
8417 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8418 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8419
8420 if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8421 {
8422 bfd_byte *loc;
8423 bfd_vma plt_address, plt_index, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
8424 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8425 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8426
8427 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8428 BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
8429 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
8430
8431 /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry. */
8432 plt_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
8433 + htab->splt->output_offset
8434 + h->plt.offset);
8435
8436 /* Calculate the index of the entry. */
8437 plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
8438 / htab->plt_entry_size);
8439
8440 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
8441 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
8442 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
8443 + plt_index * 4);
8444
8445 /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
8446 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
8447 got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
8448
8449 /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
8450 entry. The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt. */
8451 branch_offset = -(h->plt.offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
8452
8453 /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry. */
8454 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
8455 htab->sgotplt->contents + plt_index * 4);
8456
8457 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
8458 loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
8459
8460 if (info->shared)
8461 {
8462 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
8463 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8464 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8465 }
8466 else
8467 {
8468 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
8469
8470 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
8471 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8472 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
8473
8474 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8475 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8476 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
8477 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
8478 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8479 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8480 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
8481 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
8482
8483 loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
8484 + (plt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8485
8486 /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry. */
8487 rel.r_offset = got_address;
8488 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8489 rel.r_addend = h->plt.offset;
8490 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8491
8492 /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>). */
8493 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8494 rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
8495 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8496 rel.r_addend = got_offset;
8497 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8498
8499 /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>). */
8500 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8501 rel.r_offset += 4;
8502 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8503 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8504 }
8505
8506 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
8507 loc = htab->srelplt->contents + plt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8508 rel.r_offset = got_address;
8509 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
8510 rel.r_addend = 0;
8511 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8512
8513 if (!h->def_regular)
8514 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8515 }
8516
8517 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
8518
8519 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8520 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8521 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8522 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8523 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8524
8525 /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT. */
8526 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8527 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8528 {
8529 bfd_vma offset;
8530 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
8531 bfd_byte *loc;
8532 asection *s;
8533
8534 /* Install the symbol value in the GOT. */
8535 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
8536 R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8537 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
8538
8539 /* Add a dynamic relocation for it. */
8540 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8541 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8542 outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
8543 + sgot->output_offset
8544 + offset);
8545 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
8546 outrel.r_addend = 0;
8547 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
8548 }
8549
8550 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
8551 if (h->needs_copy)
8552 {
8553 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8554
8555 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8556
8557 rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8558 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8559 + h->root.u.def.value);
8560 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
8561 rel.r_addend = 0;
8562 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel,
8563 htab->srelbss->contents
8564 + (htab->srelbss->reloc_count
8565 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
8566 ++htab->srelbss->reloc_count;
8567 }
8568
8569 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
8570 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8571 sym->st_value &= ~1;
8572
8573 return TRUE;
8574 }
8575
8576 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
8577 contents of .rela.plt.unloaded. */
8578
8579 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8580 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8581 {
8582 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
8583 bfd_byte *loc;
8584 bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
8585 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8586 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8587
8588 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8589 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
8590
8591 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
8592 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8593 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8594 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
8595
8596 got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8597 got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
8598
8599 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
8600 plt_address = htab->splt->output_section->vma + htab->splt->output_offset;
8601
8602 /* Install the PLT header. */
8603 loc = htab->splt->contents;
8604 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
8605 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
8606 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
8607 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
8608 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8609 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8610
8611 /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
8612 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
8613 rela.r_offset = plt_address;
8614 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8615 rela.r_addend = 0;
8616 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8617 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8618
8619 /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
8620 %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
8621 rela.r_offset += 4;
8622 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8623 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8624 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8625
8626 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
8627 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
8628 in which symbols were output. */
8629 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
8630 {
8631 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8632
8633 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8634 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8635 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8636 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8637
8638 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8639 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8640 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8641 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8642
8643 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8644 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8645 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8646 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8647 }
8648 }
8649
8650 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library. */
8651
8652 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8653 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8654 {
8655 unsigned int i;
8656 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8657
8658 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8659
8660 /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte. */
8661 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
8662 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
8663 htab->splt->contents + i * 4);
8664 }
8665
8666 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
8667
8668 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8669 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8670 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8671 {
8672 bfd *dynobj;
8673 asection *sdyn;
8674 asection *sgot;
8675 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
8676 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8677
8678 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8679 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8680
8681 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
8682
8683 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8684 if (sgot == NULL)
8685 gg = g = NULL;
8686 else
8687 {
8688 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8689 gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8690 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
8691 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
8692 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8693 }
8694
8695 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8696 {
8697 bfd_byte *b;
8698 int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
8699
8700 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8701 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8702
8703 for (b = sdyn->contents;
8704 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8705 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8706 {
8707 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8708 const char *name;
8709 size_t elemsize;
8710 asection *s;
8711 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8712
8713 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
8714 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8715
8716 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
8717 swap_out_p = TRUE;
8718
8719 switch (dyn.d_tag)
8720 {
8721 case DT_RELENT:
8722 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
8723 break;
8724
8725 case DT_RELAENT:
8726 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8727 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
8728 break;
8729
8730 case DT_STRSZ:
8731 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
8732 dyn.d_un.d_val =
8733 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
8734 break;
8735
8736 case DT_PLTGOT:
8737 name = ".got";
8738 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8739 {
8740 /* _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ is defined to be the beginning
8741 of the ".got" section in DYNOBJ. */
8742 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, name);
8743 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8744 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8745 }
8746 else
8747 {
8748 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8749 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8750 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8751 }
8752 break;
8753
8754 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
8755 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
8756 break;
8757
8758 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
8759 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
8760 break;
8761
8762 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
8763 {
8764 time_t t;
8765 time (&t);
8766 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
8767 }
8768 break;
8769
8770 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
8771 /* XXX FIXME: */
8772 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8773 break;
8774
8775 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
8776 /* XXX FIXME: */
8777 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8778 break;
8779
8780 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
8781 s = output_bfd->sections;
8782 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8783 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
8784 break;
8785
8786 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
8787 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
8788 break;
8789
8790 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
8791 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
8792 entry of the first external symbol that is not
8793 referenced within the same object. */
8794 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
8795 break;
8796
8797 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
8798 if (gg->global_gotsym)
8799 {
8800 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
8801 break;
8802 }
8803 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
8804 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
8805 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
8806
8807 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
8808 name = ".dynsym";
8809 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
8810 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8811 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8812
8813 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
8814 break;
8815
8816 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
8817 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
8818 break;
8819
8820 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
8821 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
8822 break;
8823
8824 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
8825 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
8826 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
8827 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8828 break;
8829
8830 case DT_RELASZ:
8831 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8832 /* The count does not include the JUMP_SLOT relocations. */
8833 if (htab->srelplt)
8834 dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->size;
8835 break;
8836
8837 case DT_PLTREL:
8838 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8839 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
8840 break;
8841
8842 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
8843 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8844 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->size;
8845 break;
8846
8847 case DT_JMPREL:
8848 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8849 dyn.d_un.d_val = (htab->srelplt->output_section->vma
8850 + htab->srelplt->output_offset);
8851 break;
8852
8853 case DT_TEXTREL:
8854 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
8855 the dynamic tag. */
8856 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8857 {
8858 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
8859 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8860 }
8861 break;
8862
8863 case DT_FLAGS:
8864 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
8865 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS. */
8866 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8867 dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
8868 else
8869 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8870 break;
8871
8872 default:
8873 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8874 break;
8875 }
8876
8877 if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
8878 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
8879 (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
8880
8881 if (dyn_to_skip)
8882 {
8883 dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
8884 dyn_to_skip = 0;
8885 }
8886 }
8887
8888 /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag. */
8889 if (dyn_skipped > 0)
8890 memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
8891 }
8892
8893 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0)
8894 {
8895 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8896 {
8897 /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
8898 ".dynamic" section. The second is initialized by the
8899 loader and contains the shared library identifier.
8900 The third is also initialized by the loader and points
8901 to the lazy resolution stub. */
8902 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
8903 sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
8904 sgot->contents);
8905 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8906 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8907 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8908 sgot->contents
8909 + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8910 }
8911 else
8912 {
8913 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
8914 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
8915 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
8916 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
8917 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0x80000000,
8918 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8919 }
8920
8921 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
8922 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8923 }
8924
8925 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
8926 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
8927 {
8928 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8929 bfd_vma addend = 0;
8930
8931 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8932 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
8933
8934 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8935 {
8936 bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
8937 + g->next->tls_gotno;
8938
8939 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
8940 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8941 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
8942 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8943
8944 if (! info->shared)
8945 continue;
8946
8947 while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
8948 {
8949 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
8950 = index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8951 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8952 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
8953 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
8954 0, &addend, sgot)))
8955 return FALSE;
8956 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
8957 }
8958 }
8959 }
8960
8961 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
8962 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
8963 here. */
8964
8965 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8966 {
8967 bfd_byte *b;
8968 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8969
8970 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8971
8972 for (b = sdyn->contents;
8973 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8974 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8975 {
8976 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8977 asection *s;
8978
8979 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
8980 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8981
8982 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
8983 swap_out_p = TRUE;
8984
8985 switch (dyn.d_tag)
8986 {
8987 case DT_RELSZ:
8988 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
8989 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
8990 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
8991 are trailing null entries. */
8992 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8993 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
8994 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
8995 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
8996 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
8997 /* Adjust the section size too. Tools like the prelinker
8998 can reasonably expect the values to the same. */
8999 elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
9000 = dyn.d_un.d_val;
9001 break;
9002
9003 default:
9004 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9005 break;
9006 }
9007
9008 if (swap_out_p)
9009 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
9010 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
9011 }
9012 }
9013
9014 {
9015 asection *s;
9016 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
9017
9018 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
9019 {
9020 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
9021 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
9022 if (s != NULL)
9023 {
9024 cpt.id1 = 1;
9025 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
9026 cpt.id2 = 2;
9027 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
9028 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
9029 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
9030 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
9031 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
9032 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
9033 s->contents));
9034
9035 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
9036 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
9037 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
9038 if (s != NULL)
9039 {
9040 file_ptr dummy_offset;
9041
9042 BFD_ASSERT (s->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
9043 dummy_offset = s->size - htab->function_stub_size;
9044 memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
9045 htab->function_stub_size);
9046 }
9047 }
9048 }
9049
9050 /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
9051 increasing order of r_symndx. The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
9052 this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
9053 relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful. */
9054 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9055 {
9056 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9057 if (s != NULL
9058 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
9059 {
9060 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
9061
9062 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9063 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9064 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
9065 sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
9066 else
9067 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9068 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
9069 sort_dynamic_relocs);
9070 }
9071 }
9072 }
9073
9074 if (htab->is_vxworks && htab->splt->size > 0)
9075 {
9076 if (info->shared)
9077 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
9078 else
9079 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
9080 }
9081 return TRUE;
9082 }
9083
9084
9085 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
9086
9087 static void
mips_set_isa_flags(bfd * abfd)9088 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
9089 {
9090 flagword val;
9091
9092 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
9093 {
9094 default:
9095 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
9096 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
9097 break;
9098
9099 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
9100 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
9101 break;
9102
9103 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
9104 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
9105 break;
9106
9107 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
9108 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
9109 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
9110 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
9111 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
9112 break;
9113
9114 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
9115 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
9116 break;
9117
9118 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
9119 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
9120 break;
9121
9122 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
9123 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
9124 break;
9125
9126 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
9127 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
9128 break;
9129
9130 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
9131 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
9132 break;
9133
9134 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
9135 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
9136 break;
9137
9138 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
9139 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
9140 break;
9141
9142 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
9143 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
9144 break;
9145
9146 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
9147 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
9148 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
9149 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
9150 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
9151 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
9152 break;
9153
9154 case bfd_mach_mips5:
9155 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
9156 break;
9157
9158 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
9159 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
9160 break;
9161
9162 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
9163 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
9164 break;
9165
9166 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
9167 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
9168 break;
9169
9170 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
9171 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
9172 break;
9173
9174 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
9175 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
9176 break;
9177
9178 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
9179 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
9180 break;
9181 }
9182 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9183 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
9184
9185 }
9186
9187
9188 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
9189 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
9190 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
9191
9192 void
_bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9193 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
9194 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9195 {
9196 unsigned int i;
9197 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
9198 const char *name;
9199 asection *sec;
9200
9201 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
9202 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
9203 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
9204 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
9205 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
9206
9207 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
9208 info for each special section. */
9209 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
9210 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
9211 i++, hdrpp++)
9212 {
9213 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
9214 {
9215 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
9216 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
9217 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
9218 if (sec != NULL)
9219 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9220 break;
9221
9222 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
9223 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9224 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9225 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9226 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
9227 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
9228 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9229 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9230 break;
9231
9232 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
9233 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9234 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9235 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9236 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
9237 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9238 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
9239 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9240 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9241 break;
9242
9243 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
9244 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
9245 if (sec != NULL)
9246 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9247 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
9248 if (sec != NULL)
9249 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9250 break;
9251
9252 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
9253 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9254 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9255 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
9256 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
9257 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9258 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
9259 else
9260 {
9261 BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
9262 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9263 (name
9264 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
9265 }
9266 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9267 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9268 break;
9269
9270 }
9271 }
9272 }
9273
9274 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
9275 segments. */
9276
9277 int
_bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9278 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
9279 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9280 {
9281 asection *s;
9282 int ret = 0;
9283
9284 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
9285 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9286 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
9287 ++ret;
9288
9289 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
9290 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
9291 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9292 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
9293 ++ret;
9294
9295 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
9296 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
9297 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
9298 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
9299 ++ret;
9300
9301 /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects. See
9302 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details. */
9303 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9304 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9305 ++ret;
9306
9307 return ret;
9308 }
9309
9310 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
9311
9312 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9313 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
9314 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9315 {
9316 asection *s;
9317 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
9318 bfd_size_type amt;
9319
9320 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
9321 segment. */
9322 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9323 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9324 {
9325 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9326 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
9327 break;
9328 if (m == NULL)
9329 {
9330 amt = sizeof *m;
9331 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9332 if (m == NULL)
9333 return FALSE;
9334
9335 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
9336 m->count = 1;
9337 m->sections[0] = s;
9338
9339 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
9340 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9341 while (*pm != NULL
9342 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9343 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9344 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9345
9346 m->next = *pm;
9347 *pm = m;
9348 }
9349 }
9350
9351 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
9352 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
9353 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
9354 table. */
9355 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
9356 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
9357 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
9358 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
9359 now. */
9360 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
9361 {
9362 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
9363 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9364 break;
9365
9366 if (s)
9367 {
9368 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
9369
9370 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9371 while (*pm != NULL
9372 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9373 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9374 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9375
9376 if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9377 {
9378 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
9379 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9380 options_segment->next = *pm;
9381 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
9382 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
9383 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
9384 options_segment->count = 1;
9385 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
9386 *pm = options_segment;
9387 }
9388 }
9389 }
9390 else
9391 {
9392 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
9393 {
9394 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
9395 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
9396 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
9397 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
9398 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
9399 {
9400 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9401 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
9402 break;
9403 if (m == NULL)
9404 {
9405 amt = sizeof *m;
9406 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9407 if (m == NULL)
9408 return FALSE;
9409
9410 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
9411
9412 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9413 if (s == NULL)
9414 {
9415 m->count = 0;
9416 m->p_flags = 0;
9417 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9418 }
9419 else
9420 {
9421 m->count = 1;
9422 m->sections[0] = s;
9423 }
9424
9425 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
9426 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9427 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
9428 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9429 if (*pm != NULL)
9430 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9431
9432 m->next = *pm;
9433 *pm = m;
9434 }
9435 }
9436 }
9437 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
9438 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
9439 between. */
9440 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
9441 pm = &(*pm)->next)
9442 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
9443 break;
9444 m = *pm;
9445 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
9446 {
9447 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
9448 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
9449 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
9450 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
9451 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
9452 {
9453 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
9454 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9455 }
9456 }
9457 /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
9458 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
9459 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
9460 arrays of that size. An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
9461 be actively harmful in such cases. Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
9462 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
9463 which might move one of the other sections to a different
9464 PT_LOAD segment. */
9465 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9466 && m != NULL
9467 && m->count == 1
9468 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
9469 {
9470 static const char *sec_names[] =
9471 {
9472 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
9473 };
9474 bfd_vma low, high;
9475 unsigned int i, c;
9476 struct elf_segment_map *n;
9477
9478 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
9479 high = 0;
9480 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
9481 {
9482 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
9483 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9484 {
9485 bfd_size_type sz;
9486
9487 if (low > s->vma)
9488 low = s->vma;
9489 sz = s->size;
9490 if (high < s->vma + sz)
9491 high = s->vma + sz;
9492 }
9493 }
9494
9495 c = 0;
9496 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9497 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9498 && s->vma >= low
9499 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9500 ++c;
9501
9502 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
9503 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9504 if (n == NULL)
9505 return FALSE;
9506 *n = *m;
9507 n->count = c;
9508
9509 i = 0;
9510 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9511 {
9512 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9513 && s->vma >= low
9514 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9515 {
9516 n->sections[i] = s;
9517 ++i;
9518 }
9519 }
9520
9521 *pm = n;
9522 }
9523 }
9524
9525 /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
9526 like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
9527
9528 If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
9529 standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
9530 the new (writable) segment. However, the MIPS ABI requires
9531 .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
9532 start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
9533
9534 Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
9535 writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
9536 header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
9537 There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
9538 so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
9539 extension. */
9540 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9541 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9542 {
9543 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
9544 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
9545 break;
9546 if (*pm == NULL)
9547 {
9548 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
9549 if (m == NULL)
9550 return FALSE;
9551
9552 m->p_type = PT_NULL;
9553 *pm = m;
9554 }
9555 }
9556
9557 return TRUE;
9558 }
9559
9560 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
9561 relocation. */
9562
9563 asection *
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook(asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)9564 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
9565 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9566 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
9567 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9568 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9569 {
9570 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
9571
9572 if (h != NULL)
9573 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
9574 {
9575 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
9576 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
9577 return NULL;
9578 }
9579
9580 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
9581 }
9582
9583 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
9584
9585 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9586 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9587 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9588 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9589 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9590 {
9591 #if 0
9592 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9593 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
9594 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
9595 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
9596 unsigned long r_symndx;
9597 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9598
9599 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
9600 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
9601 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
9602
9603 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
9604 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
9605 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
9606 {
9607 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
9608 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
9609 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9610 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9611 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9612 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9613 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
9614 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9615 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
9616 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
9617 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
9618 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
9619 break;
9620
9621 default:
9622 break;
9623 }
9624 #endif
9625
9626 return TRUE;
9627 }
9628
9629 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
9630 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
9631 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
9632 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
9633
9634 void
_bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * dir,struct elf_link_hash_entry * ind)9635 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9636 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
9637 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
9638 {
9639 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
9640
9641 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
9642
9643 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9644 return;
9645
9646 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
9647 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
9648 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
9649 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
9650 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
9651 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
9652 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
9653
9654 if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
9655 dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
9656 }
9657
9658 void
_bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * entry,bfd_boolean force_local)9659 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9660 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
9661 bfd_boolean force_local)
9662 {
9663 bfd *dynobj;
9664 asection *got;
9665 struct mips_got_info *g;
9666 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9667
9668 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
9669 if (h->forced_local)
9670 return;
9671 h->forced_local = force_local;
9672
9673 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9674 if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS
9675 && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, TRUE)) != NULL
9676 && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL)
9677 {
9678 if (g->next)
9679 {
9680 struct mips_got_entry e;
9681 struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
9682
9683 /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
9684 local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
9685 that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease
9686 the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
9687 the upper limit of global entries. */
9688 e.abfd = dynobj;
9689 e.symndx = -1;
9690 e.d.h = h;
9691 e.tls_type = 0;
9692
9693 for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
9694 if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
9695 {
9696 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9697 g->local_gotno++;
9698 g->global_gotno--;
9699 }
9700
9701 /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
9702 no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry
9703 at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
9704 of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */
9705 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
9706 {
9707 BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
9708 gg->assigned_gotno--;
9709 }
9710 }
9711 else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
9712 /* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
9713 number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
9714 global. */
9715 g->local_gotno++;
9716 else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
9717 {
9718 /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
9719 been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
9720 instead. */
9721 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9722 g->local_gotno++;
9723 g->global_gotno--;
9724 }
9725 }
9726
9727 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
9728 }
9729
9730 #define PDR_SIZE 32
9731
9732 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_discard_info(bfd * abfd,struct elf_reloc_cookie * cookie,struct bfd_link_info * info)9733 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
9734 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9735 {
9736 asection *o;
9737 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
9738 unsigned char *tdata;
9739 size_t i, skip;
9740
9741 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
9742 if (! o)
9743 return FALSE;
9744 if (o->size == 0)
9745 return FALSE;
9746 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
9747 return FALSE;
9748 if (o->output_section != NULL
9749 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
9750 return FALSE;
9751
9752 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
9753 if (! tdata)
9754 return FALSE;
9755
9756 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
9757 info->keep_memory);
9758 if (!cookie->rels)
9759 {
9760 free (tdata);
9761 return FALSE;
9762 }
9763
9764 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
9765 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
9766
9767 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
9768 {
9769 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
9770 {
9771 tdata[i] = 1;
9772 skip ++;
9773 }
9774 }
9775
9776 if (skip != 0)
9777 {
9778 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
9779 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
9780 ret = TRUE;
9781 }
9782 else
9783 free (tdata);
9784
9785 if (! info->keep_memory)
9786 free (cookie->rels);
9787
9788 return ret;
9789 }
9790
9791 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs(asection * sec)9792 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
9793 {
9794 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
9795 return TRUE;
9796 return FALSE;
9797 }
9798
9799 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_write_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,bfd_byte * contents)9800 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
9801 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9802 asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
9803 {
9804 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
9805 int i;
9806
9807 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
9808 return FALSE;
9809
9810 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
9811 return FALSE;
9812
9813 to = contents;
9814 end = contents + sec->size;
9815 for (from = contents, i = 0;
9816 from < end;
9817 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
9818 {
9819 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
9820 continue;
9821 if (to != from)
9822 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
9823 to += PDR_SIZE;
9824 }
9825 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
9826 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
9827 return TRUE;
9828 }
9829
9830 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
9831 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
9832
9833 struct mips_elf_find_line
9834 {
9835 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
9836 struct ecoff_find_line i;
9837 };
9838
9839 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line(bfd * abfd,asection * section,asymbol ** symbols,bfd_vma offset,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9840 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
9841 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
9842 const char **filename_ptr,
9843 const char **functionname_ptr,
9844 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9845 {
9846 asection *msec;
9847
9848 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9849 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9850 line_ptr))
9851 return TRUE;
9852
9853 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9854 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9855 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
9856 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9857 return TRUE;
9858
9859 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
9860 if (msec != NULL)
9861 {
9862 flagword origflags;
9863 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
9864 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
9865 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
9866
9867 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
9868 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
9869 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
9870 origflags = msec->flags;
9871 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
9872 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9873
9874 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
9875 if (fi == NULL)
9876 {
9877 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
9878 char *fraw_src;
9879 char *fraw_end;
9880 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
9881 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
9882
9883 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9884 if (fi == NULL)
9885 {
9886 msec->flags = origflags;
9887 return FALSE;
9888 }
9889
9890 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
9891 {
9892 msec->flags = origflags;
9893 return FALSE;
9894 }
9895
9896 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
9897 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
9898 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
9899 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
9900 {
9901 msec->flags = origflags;
9902 return FALSE;
9903 }
9904 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
9905 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
9906 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
9907 fraw_end = (fraw_src
9908 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
9909 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
9910 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
9911
9912 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
9913
9914 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
9915 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
9916 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
9917 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
9918 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
9919 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
9920 }
9921
9922 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
9923 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9924 line_ptr))
9925 {
9926 msec->flags = origflags;
9927 return TRUE;
9928 }
9929
9930 msec->flags = origflags;
9931 }
9932
9933 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
9934
9935 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9936 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9937 line_ptr);
9938 }
9939
9940 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info(bfd * abfd,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9941 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9942 const char **filename_ptr,
9943 const char **functionname_ptr,
9944 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9945 {
9946 bfd_boolean found;
9947 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9948 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9949 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9950 return found;
9951 }
9952
9953
9954 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
9955 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
9956 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
9957
9958 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents(bfd * abfd,sec_ptr section,const void * location,file_ptr offset,bfd_size_type count)9959 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
9960 const void *location,
9961 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
9962 {
9963 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
9964 {
9965 bfd_byte *c;
9966
9967 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9968 {
9969 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
9970 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9971 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9972 return FALSE;
9973 }
9974 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
9975 if (c == NULL)
9976 {
9977 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
9978 if (c == NULL)
9979 return FALSE;
9980 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
9981 }
9982
9983 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
9984 }
9985
9986 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
9987 count);
9988 }
9989
9990 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
9991 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
9992
9993 bfd_byte *
_bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,struct bfd_link_order * link_order,bfd_byte * data,bfd_boolean relocatable,asymbol ** symbols)9994 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
9995 (bfd *abfd,
9996 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9997 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
9998 bfd_byte *data,
9999 bfd_boolean relocatable,
10000 asymbol **symbols)
10001 {
10002 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
10003 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
10004 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
10005 bfd_size_type sz;
10006
10007 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
10008 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
10009 long reloc_count;
10010
10011 if (reloc_size < 0)
10012 goto error_return;
10013
10014 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
10015 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
10016 goto error_return;
10017
10018 /* read in the section */
10019 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
10020 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
10021 goto error_return;
10022
10023 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
10024 input_section,
10025 reloc_vector,
10026 symbols);
10027 if (reloc_count < 0)
10028 goto error_return;
10029
10030 if (reloc_count > 0)
10031 {
10032 arelent **parent;
10033 /* for mips */
10034 int gp_found;
10035 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
10036
10037 {
10038 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
10039 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
10040 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
10041 if (abfd && input_bfd
10042 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
10043 lh = 0;
10044 else
10045 {
10046 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
10047 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
10048 }
10049 lookup:
10050 if (lh)
10051 {
10052 switch (lh->type)
10053 {
10054 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
10055 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
10056 case bfd_link_hash_common:
10057 gp_found = 0;
10058 break;
10059 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
10060 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
10061 gp_found = 1;
10062 gp = lh->u.def.value;
10063 break;
10064 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
10065 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
10066 lh = lh->u.i.link;
10067 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
10068 goto lookup;
10069 case bfd_link_hash_new:
10070 default:
10071 abort ();
10072 }
10073 }
10074 else
10075 gp_found = 0;
10076 }
10077 /* end mips */
10078 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
10079 {
10080 char *error_message = NULL;
10081 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
10082
10083 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
10084 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
10085 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
10086
10087 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
10088 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
10089 to the generic handling. */
10090 if (gp_found
10091 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
10092 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
10093 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
10094 input_section, relocatable,
10095 data, gp);
10096 else
10097 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
10098 input_section,
10099 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
10100 &error_message);
10101
10102 if (relocatable)
10103 {
10104 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
10105
10106 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
10107 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
10108 os->reloc_count++;
10109 }
10110
10111 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
10112 {
10113 switch (r)
10114 {
10115 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
10116 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
10117 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10118 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
10119 goto error_return;
10120 break;
10121 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
10122 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
10123 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
10124 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
10125 (*parent)->address)))
10126 goto error_return;
10127 break;
10128 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
10129 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
10130 (link_info, NULL,
10131 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10132 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
10133 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
10134 goto error_return;
10135 break;
10136 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
10137 default:
10138 abort ();
10139 break;
10140 }
10141
10142 }
10143 }
10144 }
10145 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10146 free (reloc_vector);
10147 return data;
10148
10149 error_return:
10150 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10151 free (reloc_vector);
10152 return NULL;
10153 }
10154
10155 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
10156
10157 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10158 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10159 {
10160 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
10161 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
10162
10163 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
10164 if (ret == NULL)
10165 return NULL;
10166
10167 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
10168 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
10169 sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry)))
10170 {
10171 free (ret);
10172 return NULL;
10173 }
10174
10175 #if 0
10176 /* We no longer use this. */
10177 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
10178 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
10179 #endif
10180 ret->procedure_count = 0;
10181 ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
10182 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
10183 ret->rld_value = 0;
10184 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
10185 ret->is_vxworks = FALSE;
10186 ret->srelbss = NULL;
10187 ret->sdynbss = NULL;
10188 ret->srelplt = NULL;
10189 ret->srelplt2 = NULL;
10190 ret->sgotplt = NULL;
10191 ret->splt = NULL;
10192 ret->plt_header_size = 0;
10193 ret->plt_entry_size = 0;
10194 ret->function_stub_size = 0;
10195
10196 return &ret->root.root;
10197 }
10198
10199 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks. */
10200
10201 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10202 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10203 {
10204 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10205
10206 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10207 if (ret)
10208 {
10209 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10210
10211 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
10212 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10213 }
10214 return ret;
10215 }
10216
10217 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
10218 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
10219 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
10220
10221 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_final_link(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)10222 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10223 {
10224 asection *o;
10225 struct bfd_link_order *p;
10226 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
10227 asection *rtproc_sec;
10228 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
10229 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
10230 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10231 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
10232 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
10233 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
10234 asection *s;
10235 EXTR esym;
10236 unsigned int i;
10237 bfd_size_type amt;
10238 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10239
10240 static const char * const secname[] =
10241 {
10242 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
10243 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
10244 };
10245 static const int sc[] =
10246 {
10247 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
10248 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
10249 };
10250
10251 /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
10252 generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
10253 Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
10254 the sort again. */
10255 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10256 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10257 {
10258 bfd *dynobj;
10259 asection *got;
10260 struct mips_got_info *g;
10261 bfd_size_type dynsecsymcount;
10262
10263 /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
10264 the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section
10265 symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only
10266 adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that
10267 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
10268 section above. */
10269
10270 dynsecsymcount = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info);
10271 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, dynsecsymcount + 1))
10272 return FALSE;
10273
10274 /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */
10275 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10276 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
10277 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
10278
10279 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
10280 BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
10281 - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
10282 <= g->global_gotno);
10283 }
10284
10285 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
10286 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
10287 {
10288 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
10289
10290 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10291 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10292 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
10293 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10294 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
10295 else if (htab->is_vxworks
10296 && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
10297 "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
10298 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
10299 && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10300 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10301 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
10302 + h->u.def.value);
10303 else if (info->relocatable)
10304 {
10305 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
10306
10307 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
10308 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10309 if (o->vma < lo
10310 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
10311 lo = o->vma;
10312
10313 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
10314 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
10315 }
10316 else
10317 {
10318 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
10319 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
10320 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
10321 }
10322 }
10323
10324 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
10325 information. */
10326 reginfo_sec = NULL;
10327 mdebug_sec = NULL;
10328 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
10329 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
10330 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10331 {
10332 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
10333 {
10334 memset (®info, 0, sizeof reginfo);
10335
10336 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
10337 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10338 the information together. */
10339 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10340 {
10341 asection *input_section;
10342 bfd *input_bfd;
10343 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10344 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
10345
10346 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10347 {
10348 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10349 continue;
10350 abort ();
10351 }
10352
10353 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10354 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10355
10356 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
10357 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10358 return FALSE;
10359
10360 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
10361
10362 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
10363 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
10364 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
10365 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
10366 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
10367
10368 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
10369 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
10370 finally written out. */
10371
10372 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10373 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10374 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10375 }
10376
10377 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
10378 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
10379
10380 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10381 matters, but someday it might). */
10382 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10383
10384 reginfo_sec = o;
10385 }
10386
10387 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
10388 {
10389 struct extsym_info einfo;
10390 bfd_vma last;
10391
10392 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
10393 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10394 the information together. */
10395 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
10396 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
10397 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
10398 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
10399 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
10400 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
10401 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
10402 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
10403 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
10404 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
10405 symhdr->issMax = 0;
10406 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
10407 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
10408 symhdr->crfd = 0;
10409 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
10410
10411 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
10412 debug_info structure. */
10413 debug.line = NULL;
10414 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
10415 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
10416 debug.external_sym = NULL;
10417 debug.external_opt = NULL;
10418 debug.external_aux = NULL;
10419 debug.ss = NULL;
10420 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
10421 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
10422 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
10423 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
10424
10425 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10426 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
10427 return FALSE;
10428
10429 esym.jmptbl = 0;
10430 esym.cobol_main = 0;
10431 esym.weakext = 0;
10432 esym.reserved = 0;
10433 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
10434 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
10435 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
10436 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
10437 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
10438 last = 0;
10439 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
10440 {
10441 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
10442 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
10443 if (s != NULL)
10444 {
10445 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
10446 last = s->vma + s->size;
10447 }
10448 else
10449 esym.asym.value = last;
10450 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
10451 secname[i], &esym))
10452 return FALSE;
10453 }
10454
10455 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10456 {
10457 asection *input_section;
10458 bfd *input_bfd;
10459 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
10460 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
10461 char *eraw_src;
10462 char *eraw_end;
10463
10464 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10465 {
10466 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10467 continue;
10468 abort ();
10469 }
10470
10471 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10472 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10473
10474 if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
10475 || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10476 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
10477 {
10478 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
10479 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
10480 want to deal with it. */
10481 continue;
10482 }
10483
10484 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10485 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
10486
10487 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
10488
10489 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
10490 read in the debugging information and set up an
10491 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
10492 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
10493 &input_debug))
10494 return FALSE;
10495
10496 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
10497 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
10498 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
10499 return FALSE;
10500
10501 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
10502 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
10503 the linker global hash table and save the information
10504 for the output external symbols. */
10505 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
10506 eraw_end = (eraw_src
10507 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
10508 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
10509 for (;
10510 eraw_src < eraw_end;
10511 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
10512 {
10513 EXTR ext;
10514 const char *name;
10515 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10516
10517 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
10518 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
10519 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
10520 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
10521 continue;
10522
10523 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
10524 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10525 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10526 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
10527 continue;
10528
10529 if (ext.ifd != -1)
10530 {
10531 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
10532 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
10533 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
10534 }
10535
10536 h->esym = ext;
10537 }
10538
10539 /* Free up the information we just read. */
10540 free (input_debug.line);
10541 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
10542 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
10543 free (input_debug.external_sym);
10544 free (input_debug.external_opt);
10545 free (input_debug.external_aux);
10546 free (input_debug.ss);
10547 free (input_debug.ssext);
10548 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
10549 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
10550 free (input_debug.external_ext);
10551
10552 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10553 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10554 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10555 }
10556
10557 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
10558 {
10559 /* Create .rtproc section. */
10560 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10561 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
10562 {
10563 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
10564 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
10565
10566 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
10567 ".rtproc",
10568 flags);
10569 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
10570 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
10571 return FALSE;
10572 }
10573
10574 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
10575 info, rtproc_sec,
10576 &debug))
10577 return FALSE;
10578 }
10579
10580 /* Build the external symbol information. */
10581 einfo.abfd = abfd;
10582 einfo.info = info;
10583 einfo.debug = &debug;
10584 einfo.swap = swap;
10585 einfo.failed = FALSE;
10586 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10587 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
10588 if (einfo.failed)
10589 return FALSE;
10590
10591 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
10592 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
10593
10594 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10595 matters, but someday it might). */
10596 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10597
10598 mdebug_sec = o;
10599 }
10600
10601 if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
10602 {
10603 const char *subname;
10604 unsigned int c;
10605 Elf32_gptab *tab;
10606 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
10607 unsigned int j;
10608
10609 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
10610 information describing how the small data area would
10611 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
10612 not used in executables files. */
10613 if (! info->relocatable)
10614 {
10615 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10616 {
10617 asection *input_section;
10618
10619 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10620 {
10621 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10622 continue;
10623 abort ();
10624 }
10625
10626 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10627
10628 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10629 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10630 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10631 }
10632
10633 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
10634 currently matters, but someday it might). */
10635 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10636
10637 /* Really remove the section. */
10638 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
10639 --abfd->section_count;
10640
10641 continue;
10642 }
10643
10644 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
10645 uninitialized data. */
10646 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
10647 gptab_data_sec = o;
10648 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
10649 gptab_bss_sec = o;
10650 else
10651 {
10652 (*_bfd_error_handler)
10653 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
10654 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
10655 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
10656 return FALSE;
10657 }
10658
10659 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
10660 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
10661 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
10662 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
10663 case we must change the name of the output section. */
10664 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10665 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
10666 {
10667 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
10668 o->name = ".gptab.data";
10669 else
10670 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
10671 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10672 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
10673 }
10674
10675 /* Set up the first entry. */
10676 c = 1;
10677 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10678 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
10679 if (tab == NULL)
10680 return FALSE;
10681 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
10682 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
10683
10684 /* Combine the input sections. */
10685 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10686 {
10687 asection *input_section;
10688 bfd *input_bfd;
10689 bfd_size_type size;
10690 unsigned long last;
10691 bfd_size_type gpentry;
10692
10693 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10694 {
10695 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10696 continue;
10697 abort ();
10698 }
10699
10700 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10701 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10702
10703 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
10704 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
10705 sorted by ascending -G value. */
10706 size = input_section->size;
10707 last = 0;
10708 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10709 gpentry < size;
10710 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
10711 {
10712 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
10713 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
10714 unsigned long val;
10715 unsigned long add;
10716 bfd_boolean exact;
10717 unsigned int look;
10718
10719 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
10720 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
10721 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
10722 {
10723 free (tab);
10724 return FALSE;
10725 }
10726
10727 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
10728 &int_gptab);
10729 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
10730 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
10731
10732 exact = FALSE;
10733 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10734 {
10735 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
10736 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
10737
10738 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
10739 exact = TRUE;
10740 }
10741
10742 if (! exact)
10743 {
10744 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
10745 unsigned int max;
10746
10747 /* We need a new table entry. */
10748 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10749 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
10750 if (new_tab == NULL)
10751 {
10752 free (tab);
10753 return FALSE;
10754 }
10755 tab = new_tab;
10756 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
10757 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
10758
10759 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
10760 value, since that will be implied by this new
10761 value. */
10762 max = 0;
10763 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10764 {
10765 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
10766 && (max == 0
10767 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
10768 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
10769 max = look;
10770 }
10771 if (max != 0)
10772 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
10773 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10774
10775 ++c;
10776 }
10777
10778 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10779 }
10780
10781 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10782 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10783 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10784 }
10785
10786 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
10787 if (c > 2)
10788 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
10789
10790 /* Swap out the table. */
10791 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10792 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
10793 if (ext_tab == NULL)
10794 {
10795 free (tab);
10796 return FALSE;
10797 }
10798
10799 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
10800 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
10801 free (tab);
10802
10803 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10804 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
10805
10806 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10807 matters, but someday it might). */
10808 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10809 }
10810 }
10811
10812 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
10813 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
10814 return FALSE;
10815
10816 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
10817
10818 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
10819 {
10820 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10821
10822 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, ®info, &ext);
10823 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10824 return FALSE;
10825 }
10826
10827 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
10828 {
10829 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
10830 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
10831 swap, info,
10832 mdebug_sec->filepos))
10833 return FALSE;
10834
10835 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10836 }
10837
10838 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
10839 {
10840 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
10841 gptab_data_sec->contents,
10842 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
10843 return FALSE;
10844 }
10845
10846 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
10847 {
10848 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
10849 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
10850 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
10851 return FALSE;
10852 }
10853
10854 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
10855 {
10856 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10857 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
10858 {
10859 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
10860 rtproc_sec->contents,
10861 0, rtproc_sec->size))
10862 return FALSE;
10863 }
10864 }
10865
10866 return TRUE;
10867 }
10868
10869 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
10870
10871 struct mips_mach_extension {
10872 unsigned long extension, base;
10873 };
10874
10875
10876 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
10877 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
10878
10879 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
10880 /* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
10881 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
10882
10883 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
10884 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10885 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10886
10887 /* MIPS V extensions. */
10888 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
10889
10890 /* R10000 extensions. */
10891 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
10892
10893 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
10894 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
10895 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
10896 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
10897 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
10898 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
10899 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
10900
10901 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
10902 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10903 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10904 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10905 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10906 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10907
10908 /* VR4100 extensions. */
10909 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10910 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10911
10912 /* MIPS III extensions. */
10913 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10914 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10915 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10916 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10917 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10918 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10919 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10920
10921 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
10922 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
10923
10924 /* MIPS II extensions. */
10925 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10926 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10927
10928 /* MIPS I extensions. */
10929 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
10930 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
10931 };
10932
10933
10934 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
10935
10936 static bfd_boolean
mips_mach_extends_p(unsigned long base,unsigned long extension)10937 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
10938 {
10939 size_t i;
10940
10941 if (extension == base)
10942 return TRUE;
10943
10944 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
10945 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
10946 return TRUE;
10947
10948 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
10949 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
10950 return TRUE;
10951
10952 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
10953 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
10954 {
10955 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
10956 if (extension == base)
10957 return TRUE;
10958 }
10959
10960 return FALSE;
10961 }
10962
10963
10964 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
10965
10966 static bfd_boolean
mips_32bit_flags_p(flagword flags)10967 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
10968 {
10969 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
10970 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
10971 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
10972 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
10973 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
10974 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
10975 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
10976 }
10977
10978
10979 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
10980 there are conflicting attributes. */
10981 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)10982 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
10983 {
10984 obj_attribute *in_attr;
10985 obj_attribute *out_attr;
10986
10987 if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
10988 {
10989 /* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
10990 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
10991
10992 /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
10993 initialized. */
10994 elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
10995
10996 return TRUE;
10997 }
10998
10999 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
11000 non-conflicting ones. */
11001 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
11002 out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
11003 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11004 {
11005 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
11006 if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11007 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
11008 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11009 ;
11010 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11011 _bfd_error_handler
11012 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), ibfd,
11013 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11014 else if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11015 _bfd_error_handler
11016 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), obfd,
11017 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11018 else
11019 switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11020 {
11021 case 1:
11022 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11023 {
11024 case 2:
11025 _bfd_error_handler
11026 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11027 obfd, ibfd);
11028
11029 case 3:
11030 _bfd_error_handler
11031 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11032 obfd, ibfd);
11033 break;
11034
11035 default:
11036 abort ();
11037 }
11038 break;
11039
11040 case 2:
11041 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11042 {
11043 case 1:
11044 _bfd_error_handler
11045 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11046 ibfd, obfd);
11047
11048 case 3:
11049 _bfd_error_handler
11050 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11051 obfd, ibfd);
11052 break;
11053
11054 default:
11055 abort ();
11056 }
11057 break;
11058
11059 case 3:
11060 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11061 {
11062 case 1:
11063 case 2:
11064 _bfd_error_handler
11065 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11066 ibfd, obfd);
11067 break;
11068
11069 default:
11070 abort ();
11071 }
11072 break;
11073
11074 default:
11075 abort ();
11076 }
11077 }
11078
11079 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
11080 _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
11081
11082 return TRUE;
11083 }
11084
11085 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
11086 object file when linking. */
11087
11088 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)11089 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
11090 {
11091 flagword old_flags;
11092 flagword new_flags;
11093 bfd_boolean ok;
11094 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
11095 asection *sec;
11096
11097 /* Check if we have the same endianess */
11098 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
11099 {
11100 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11101 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11102 ibfd);
11103 return FALSE;
11104 }
11105
11106 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
11107 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11108 return TRUE;
11109
11110 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
11111 {
11112 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11113 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11114 ibfd);
11115 return FALSE;
11116 }
11117
11118 if (!mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
11119 return FALSE;
11120
11121 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
11122 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11123 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
11124
11125 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
11126 {
11127 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
11128 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
11129 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11130 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
11131
11132 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
11133 && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
11134 || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
11135 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
11136 {
11137 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
11138 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11139 return FALSE;
11140 }
11141
11142 return TRUE;
11143 }
11144
11145 /* Check flag compatibility. */
11146
11147 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11148 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11149
11150 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
11151 doesn't seem to matter. */
11152 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11153 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11154
11155 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
11156 just be able to ignore this. */
11157 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11158 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11159
11160 /* Don't care about the PIC flags from dynamic objects; they are
11161 PIC by design. */
11162 if ((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0
11163 && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
11164 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11165
11166 if (new_flags == old_flags)
11167 return TRUE;
11168
11169 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
11170 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
11171 actually cause any incompatibility. */
11172 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
11173 {
11174 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
11175 which are automatically generated by gas. */
11176 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
11177 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
11178 && (sec->size != 0
11179 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
11180 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
11181 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
11182 {
11183 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
11184 break;
11185 }
11186 }
11187 if (null_input_bfd)
11188 return TRUE;
11189
11190 ok = TRUE;
11191
11192 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
11193 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
11194 {
11195 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11196 (_("%B: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
11197 ibfd);
11198 ok = TRUE;
11199 }
11200
11201 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
11202 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
11203 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
11204 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
11205
11206 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11207 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11208
11209 /* Compare the ISAs. */
11210 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
11211 {
11212 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11213 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
11214 ibfd);
11215 ok = FALSE;
11216 }
11217 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
11218 {
11219 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
11220 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11221 {
11222 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
11223 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
11224 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
11225 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
11226 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
11227 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
11228 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11229
11230 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
11231 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
11232 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
11233 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
11234 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
11235 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
11236 }
11237 else
11238 {
11239 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
11240 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11241 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11242 ibfd,
11243 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
11244 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
11245 ok = FALSE;
11246 }
11247 }
11248
11249 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11250 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11251
11252 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
11253 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
11254 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
11255 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11256 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11257 {
11258 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
11259 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11260 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11261 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11262 {
11263 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11264 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11265 ibfd,
11266 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
11267 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
11268 ok = FALSE;
11269 }
11270 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11271 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11272 }
11273
11274 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
11275 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
11276 {
11277 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11278
11279 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11280 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11281 }
11282
11283 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
11284 if (new_flags != old_flags)
11285 {
11286 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11287 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
11288 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
11289 (unsigned long) old_flags);
11290 ok = FALSE;
11291 }
11292
11293 if (! ok)
11294 {
11295 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11296 return FALSE;
11297 }
11298
11299 return TRUE;
11300 }
11301
11302 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
11303
11304 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags(bfd * abfd,flagword flags)11305 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
11306 {
11307 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
11308 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
11309
11310 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
11311 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
11312 return TRUE;
11313 }
11314
11315 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data(bfd * abfd,void * ptr)11316 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
11317 {
11318 FILE *file = ptr;
11319
11320 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
11321
11322 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
11323 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
11324
11325 /* xgettext:c-format */
11326 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
11327
11328 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
11329 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
11330 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
11331 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
11332 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
11333 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
11334 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
11335 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
11336 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11337 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
11338 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
11339 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
11340 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
11341 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
11342 else
11343 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
11344
11345 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
11346 fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
11347 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
11348 fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
11349 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
11350 fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
11351 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
11352 fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
11353 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
11354 fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
11355 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
11356 fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
11357 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
11358 fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
11359 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
11360 fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
11361 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
11362 fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
11363 else
11364 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
11365
11366 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
11367 fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
11368
11369 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
11370 fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
11371
11372 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
11373 fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
11374 else
11375 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
11376
11377 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
11378 fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
11379
11380 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
11381 fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
11382
11383 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
11384 fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
11385
11386 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
11387 fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
11388
11389 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
11390 fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
11391
11392 fputc ('\n', file);
11393
11394 return TRUE;
11395 }
11396
11397 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
11398 {
11399 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11400 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11401 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
11402 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11403 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11404 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"), 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
11405 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
11406 };
11407
11408 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes. Ensure that the
11409 STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
11410 definiton of the symbol. */
11411 void
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,const Elf_Internal_Sym * isym,bfd_boolean definition,bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11412 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11413 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
11414 bfd_boolean definition,
11415 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11416 {
11417 if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
11418 {
11419 unsigned char other;
11420
11421 other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
11422 other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
11423 h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
11424 }
11425
11426 if (!definition
11427 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
11428 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
11429 }
11430
11431 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
11432 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
11433 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)11434 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
11435 {
11436 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
11437 }
11438
11439 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_common_definition(Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)11440 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11441 {
11442 return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
11443 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
11444 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
11445 }
11446